blob: 6e69fc7475cf05d776bb11ba5e2b96d409a6820c [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau02c7c142012-06-04 00:43:45 +02007 2012/06/04
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100565. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
586. HTTP header manipulation
59
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100607. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200617.1. Matching integers
627.2. Matching strings
637.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200647.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200657.5. Available matching criteria
667.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
677.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
687.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
697.6. Pre-defined ACLs
707.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100717.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072
738. Logging
748.1. Log levels
758.2. Log formats
768.2.1. Default log format
778.2.2. TCP log format
788.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100798.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200808.3. Advanced logging options
818.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
828.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
838.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
848.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
858.4. Timing events
868.5. Session state at disconnection
878.6. Non-printable characters
888.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
898.8. Capturing HTTP headers
908.9. Examples of logs
91
929. Statistics and monitoring
939.1. CSV format
949.2. Unix Socket commands
95
96
971. Quick reminder about HTTP
98----------------------------
99
100When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
101fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
102on almost anything found in the contents.
103
104However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
105formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
106correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
107
108
1091.1. The HTTP transaction model
110-------------------------------
111
112The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100113to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
115connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
116will involve a new connection :
117
118 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
119
120In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
121establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
122by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
123length.
124
125Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
126to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
127however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
128response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
129header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
130
131 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
132
133Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
134power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
135but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200136a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
138A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
139keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
140second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
141page :
142
143 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
144
145This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
146latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
147correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
148the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100149server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
152connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
153everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
154established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
155sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
156while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
157another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
158sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
159http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
160mode.
161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162
1631.2. HTTP request
164-----------------
165
166First, let's consider this HTTP request :
167
168 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100169 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
171 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
172 3 User-agent: my small browser
173 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
174 5 Accept: image/png
175
176
1771.2.1. The Request line
178-----------------------
179
180Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
181
182 - a METHOD : GET
183 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
184 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
185
186All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
187which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
188followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
189is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
190desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
191the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
192
193The URI itself can have several forms :
194
195 - A "relative URI" :
196
197 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
198
199 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
200 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
201
202 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
203
204 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
207 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
208 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
209 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
210 must accept this form too.
211
212 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
213 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
214 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
217 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
218 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
219 other protocols too.
220
221In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
222mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
223on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
224It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
225specific to the language, framework or application in use.
226
227
2281.2.2. The request headers
229--------------------------
230
231The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
232beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
233an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
234Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
235values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
236encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
237the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
238define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
239
240Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
241their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
242"Connection:" header).
243
244The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
245that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
246is one valid form of empty line.
247
248Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
249headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
250about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
251application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
252
253Important note:
254 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
255 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
256 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
257 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
258
259
2601.3. HTTP response
261------------------
262
263An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
264messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
265
266 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100267 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200268 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
269 2 Content-length: 350
270 3 Content-Type: text/html
271
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200272As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
273codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
274response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100275continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
276the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
277following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
278sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
279(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
280correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
281such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
282state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
283over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
284if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
285information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
2881.3.1. The Response line
289------------------------
290
291Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
292
293 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
294 - a status code : 200
295 - a reason : OK
296
297The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200298 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
300 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
301 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
302 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
303
304Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100305"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
307messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
308or "Authentication Required".
309
310Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
311
312 Code When / reason
313 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
314 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
316 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
317 400 for an invalid or too large request
318 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
319 accessing the stats page)
320 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
321 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
322 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
323 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
324 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
325 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
326 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
327 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
328 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
329
330The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3314.2).
332
333
3341.3.2. The response headers
335---------------------------
336
337Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
338the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
339details.
340
341
3422. Configuring HAProxy
343----------------------
344
3452.1. Configuration file format
346------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200347
348HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
349
350 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
351 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
352 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
353 "frontend" and "backend".
354
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100355The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
356referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
357delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100358preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100359escaped by doubling them.
360
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
3622.2. Time format
363----------------
364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100365Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100366values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
367otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
368numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
369for every keyword. Supported units are :
370
371 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
372 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
373 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
374 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
375 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
376 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
377
378
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003792.3. Examples
380-------------
381
382 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
383 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
384 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
385 global
386 daemon
387 maxconn 256
388
389 defaults
390 mode http
391 timeout connect 5000ms
392 timeout client 50000ms
393 timeout server 50000ms
394
395 frontend http-in
396 bind *:80
397 default_backend servers
398
399 backend servers
400 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
401
402
403 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
404 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
405 global
406 daemon
407 maxconn 256
408
409 defaults
410 mode http
411 timeout connect 5000ms
412 timeout client 50000ms
413 timeout server 50000ms
414
415 listen http-in
416 bind *:80
417 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
418
419
420Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
421
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100422 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200423
424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004253. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200426--------------------
427
428Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
429are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
430of them have command-line equivalents.
431
432The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
433
434 * Process management and security
435 - chroot
436 - daemon
437 - gid
438 - group
439 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100440 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200441 - nbproc
442 - pidfile
443 - uid
444 - ulimit-n
445 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200446 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200447 - node
448 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100449 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100450
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200451 * Performance tuning
452 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200453 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100454 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - noepoll
456 - nokqueue
457 - nopoll
458 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100459 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200460 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200461 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200462 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200463 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100464 - tune.maxaccept
465 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200466 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200467 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100468 - tune.rcvbuf.client
469 - tune.rcvbuf.server
470 - tune.sndbuf.client
471 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100472
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200473 * Debugging
474 - debug
475 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476
477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004783.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200479------------------------------------
480
481chroot <jail dir>
482 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
483 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
484 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
485 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
486 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
487 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100488
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200489daemon
490 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
491 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
492 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
493
494gid <number>
495 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
496 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
497 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
498 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100499
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200500group <group name>
501 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
502 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100503
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200504log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
506 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100507 configured with "log global".
508
509 <address> can be one of:
510
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100511 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100512 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
513 port).
514
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100515 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
516 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
517 port).
518
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100519 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
520 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
521 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
522 writeable).
523
524 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200525
526 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
527 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
528 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
529
530 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200531 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
532 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
533 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
534 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
535 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
536 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200538 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200539
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100540log-send-hostname [<string>]
541 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
542 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
543 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
544 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
545 the logs.
546
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000547log-tag <string>
548 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
549 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
550 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
551 running on the same host.
552
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200553nbproc <number>
554 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
555 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
556 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
557 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
558 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
559
560pidfile <pidfile>
561 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
562 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
563 starting the process. See also "daemon".
564
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200565stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200566 [level <level>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200567
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200568 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
569 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100570 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200571 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
572
573 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
574 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
575 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
576 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
577 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
578
579 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200580 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200581 counters).
582
583 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
584 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100585
586 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
587 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
588 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
589 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
590 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
591 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
592 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200593
594stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
595 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
596 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100597 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200598
599stats maxconn <connections>
600 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
601 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
602
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200603uid <number>
604 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
605 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
606 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
607 one. See also "gid" and "user".
608
609ulimit-n <number>
610 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
611 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
612 option.
613
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100614unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
615 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
616
617 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
618 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
619 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
620 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
621 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
622 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
623 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
624 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
625 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
626 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
627
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200628user <user name>
629 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
630 See also "uid" and "group".
631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200632node <name>
633 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
634
635 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
636 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
637 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
638 traffic.
639
640description <text>
641 Add a text that describes the instance.
642
643 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
644 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
645 "<" and ">" characters.
646
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200647
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006483.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200649-----------------------
650
651maxconn <number>
652 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
653 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
654 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
655 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
656
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200657maxconnrate <number>
658 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
659 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
660 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
661 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
662 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
663 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
664 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
665 fairness.
666
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100667maxpipes <number>
668 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
669 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
670 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
671 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
672 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
673 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
674
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675noepoll
676 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
677 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
678 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
679
680nokqueue
681 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
682 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
683 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
684
685nopoll
686 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
687 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100688 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
690 "nokqueue".
691
692nosepoll
693 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
694 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
695 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
696
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100697nosplice
698 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
699 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
700 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100701 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100702 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
703 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
704 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
705 "option splice-response".
706
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200707spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
708 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
709 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
710 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
711 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
712 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
713
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200714tune.bufsize <number>
715 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
716 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
717 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
718 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
719 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
720 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
721 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
722 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
723
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200724tune.chksize <number>
725 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
726 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
727 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
728 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
729 checks whenever possible.
730
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200731tune.http.maxhdr <number>
732 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
733 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
734 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
735 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
736 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
737 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
738 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
739 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
740 limit too high.
741
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100742tune.maxaccept <number>
743 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
744 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
745 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100746 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100747 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
748 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100749 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100750 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
751
752tune.maxpollevents <number>
753 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
754 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
755 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
756 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
757 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
758
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200759tune.maxrewrite <number>
760 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
761 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
762 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
763 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
764 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
765 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
766 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
767 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
768 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
769 bufsize.
770
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200771tune.pipesize <number>
772 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
773 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
774 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
775 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
776 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
777 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
778
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100779tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
780tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
781 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
782 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
783 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
784 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
785 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
786 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
787 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
788
789tune.sndbuf.client <number>
790tune.sndbuf.server <number>
791 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
792 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
793 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
794 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
795 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
796 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
797 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
798 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
799 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
800 notifying haproxy again.
801
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008033.3. Debugging
804--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805
806debug
807 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
808 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
809 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
810 system startup.
811
812quiet
813 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
814 line argument "-q".
815
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008173.4. Userlists
818--------------
819It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
820http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
821it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
822
823userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100824 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100825 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
826
827group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100828 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100829 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
830 proceeded by "users" keyword.
831
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100832user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
833 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100834 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
835 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100836 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
837 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100838 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
839 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
840
841
842 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100843 userlist L1
844 group G1 users tiger,scott
845 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100846
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100847 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
848 user scott insecure-password elgato
849 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100850
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100851 userlist L2
852 group G1
853 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100854
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100855 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
856 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
857 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100858
859 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200860
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200861
8623.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200863----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200864It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
865haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
866pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
867identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
868or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
869Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
870known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
871the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
872process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
873during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
874tables.
875
876peers <peersect>
877 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independant section,
878 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
879
880peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
881 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
882 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
883 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
884 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
885 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
886 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
887
888 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
889 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
890
891 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
892 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
893 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
894 across all peers.
895
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200896 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200897 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100898 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
899 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
900 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200901
902 backend mybackend
903 mode tcp
904 balance roundrobin
905 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
906 stick on src
907
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100908 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
909 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200910
911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009124. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200913----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100914
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200915Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
916 - defaults <name>
917 - frontend <name>
918 - backend <name>
919 - listen <name>
920
921A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
922its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
923section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100924section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200925
926A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
927connections.
928
929A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
930to forward incoming connections.
931
932A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
933parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
934
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100935All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
936'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
937case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
938
939Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
940logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
941proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
942However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
943name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
944
945Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
946and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100947bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100948protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
949modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
950arbitrary criteria.
951
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100952
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
954--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200956The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
957limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
958they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
959limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100960marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200961option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200962and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
963with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
964specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100965
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200966
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100967 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
968------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
969acl - X X X
970appsession - - X X
971backlog X X X -
972balance X - X X
973bind - X X -
974bind-process X X X X
975block - X X X
976capture cookie - X X -
977capture request header - X X -
978capture response header - X X -
979clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
980contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
981cookie X - X X
982default-server X - X X
983default_backend X X X -
984description - X X X
985disabled X X X X
986dispatch - - X X
987enabled X X X X
988errorfile X X X X
989errorloc X X X X
990errorloc302 X X X X
991-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
992errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200993force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100994fullconn X - X X
995grace X X X X
996hash-type X - X X
997http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100998http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200999http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001000http-request - X X X
1001id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001002ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001003log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001004maxconn X X X -
1005mode X X X X
1006monitor fail - X X -
1007monitor-net X X X -
1008monitor-uri X X X -
1009option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1010option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1011option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1012option allbackups (*) X - X X
1013option checkcache (*) X - X X
1014option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1015option contstats (*) X X X -
1016option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1017option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1018option forceclose (*) X X X X
1019-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1020option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001021option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001022option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001023option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1024option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1025option httpchk X - X X
1026option httpclose (*) X X X X
1027option httplog X X X X
1028option http_proxy (*) X X X X
1029option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001030option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001031option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1032option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1033option logasap (*) X X X -
1034option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001035option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001036option nolinger (*) X X X X
1037option originalto X X X X
1038option persist (*) X - X X
1039option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001040option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001041option smtpchk X - X X
1042option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1043option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1044option splice-request (*) X X X X
1045option splice-response (*) X X X X
1046option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1047option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1048-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1049option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1050option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1051option tcpka X X X X
1052option tcplog X X X X
1053option transparent (*) X - X X
1054persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1055rate-limit sessions X X X -
1056redirect - X X X
1057redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1058redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1059reqadd - X X X
1060reqallow - X X X
1061reqdel - X X X
1062reqdeny - X X X
1063reqiallow - X X X
1064reqidel - X X X
1065reqideny - X X X
1066reqipass - X X X
1067reqirep - X X X
1068reqisetbe - X X X
1069reqitarpit - X X X
1070reqpass - X X X
1071reqrep - X X X
1072-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1073reqsetbe - X X X
1074reqtarpit - X X X
1075retries X - X X
1076rspadd - X X X
1077rspdel - X X X
1078rspdeny - X X X
1079rspidel - X X X
1080rspideny - X X X
1081rspirep - X X X
1082rsprep - X X X
1083server - - X X
1084source X - X X
1085srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001086stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001087stats auth X - X X
1088stats enable X - X X
1089stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001090stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001091stats realm X - X X
1092stats refresh X - X X
1093stats scope X - X X
1094stats show-desc X - X X
1095stats show-legends X - X X
1096stats show-node X - X X
1097stats uri X - X X
1098-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1099stick match - - X X
1100stick on - - X X
1101stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001102stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001103stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001104tcp-request connection - X X -
1105tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001106tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001107tcp-response content - - X X
1108tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001109timeout check X - X X
1110timeout client X X X -
1111timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1112timeout connect X - X X
1113timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1114timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1115timeout http-request X X X X
1116timeout queue X - X X
1117timeout server X - X X
1118timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1119timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001120timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001121transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001122unique-id-format X X X -
1123unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001124use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001125use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001126------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1127 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001128
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011304.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1131---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001132
1133This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1134
1135
1136acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1137 Declare or complete an access list.
1138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1139 no | yes | yes | yes
1140 Example:
1141 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1142 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1143 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001145 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001146
1147
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001148appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1149 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001150 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1152 no | no | yes | yes
1153 Arguments :
1154 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1155 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1156
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001157 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001158 checked in each cookie value.
1159
1160 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1161 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1162 milliseconds.
1163
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001164 request-learn
1165 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1166 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1167 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1168 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1169 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1170 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1171
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001172 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1173 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1174 data following this prefix.
1175
1176 Example :
1177 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1178
1179 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1180 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1181
1182 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1183 2 modes are currently supported :
1184 - path-parameters :
1185 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1186 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1187 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1188 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1189 - query-string :
1190 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1191 query string.
1192
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001193 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1194 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1195 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1196 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001197 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1198 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1199 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001200 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1201 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1202
1203 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1204
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001205 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1206 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1207 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1208
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001209 Example :
1210 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1211
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001212 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1213 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001214
1215
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001216backlog <conns>
1217 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1219 yes | yes | yes | no
1220 Arguments :
1221 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1222 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001223 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001224
1225 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1226 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1227 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1228 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1229 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1230 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1231 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1232 backlog parameter.
1233
1234 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1235 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1236 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1237
1238 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1239
1240
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001241balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001242balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001243 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1245 yes | no | yes | yes
1246 Arguments :
1247 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1248 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1249 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1250 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1251
1252 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1253 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1254 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1255 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001256 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1257 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1258 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1259 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1260 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1261 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1262 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1263 it, so that you don't worry.
1264
1265 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1266 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1267 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1268 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1269 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1270 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1271 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1272 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001273
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001274 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1275 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1276 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1277 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1278 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1279 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1280 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1281 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1282
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001283 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1284 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1285 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1286 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001287 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001288 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1289 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1290 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1291 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1292 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001293 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1294 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1295 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1296 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1297 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1298 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001299
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001300 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1301 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1302 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1303 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1304 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1305 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1306 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1307 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001308 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001309 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001310 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1311 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1312 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001313
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001314 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1315 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1316 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1317 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1318 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1319 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1320 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1321 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1322 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1323 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1324 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1325 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001326
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001327 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001328 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1329 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1330 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1331 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1332 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1333 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1334 URIs start with a leading "/".
1335
1336 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1337 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1338 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1339 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1340
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001341 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001342 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1343
1344 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001345 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1346 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1347 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1348 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1349 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1350 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1351 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1352 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1353 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1354 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1355 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1356 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1357 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1358 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1359 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1360 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1361 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1362 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1363 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001364
1365 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1366 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1367 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1368 server will receive the request.
1369
1370 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1371 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1372 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1373 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1374 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001375 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1376 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1377 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001378
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001379 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1380 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1381 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1382 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1383 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001384
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001385 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001386 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1387 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1388 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1389
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001390 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1391 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1392 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1393
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001394 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001395 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001396 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1397 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1398 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1399 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1400 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1401 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001402 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001403 used instead.
1404
1405 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1406 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1407 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1408 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1409
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001410 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1411 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1412 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1413
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001414 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001416 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001417 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1418 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001419
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001420 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001421 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001422
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001423 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1424 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1425 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001426
1427 Examples :
1428 balance roundrobin
1429 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001430 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001431 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1432 balance hdr(host)
1433 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001434
1435 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1436 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001438 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001439 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1440 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1441 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1442 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1443
1444 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1445 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1446 defaults to 16 kB.
1447
1448 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1449 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1450
1451 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1452 Round Robin.
1453
1454 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1455 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1456 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1457 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1458
1459 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1460
1461 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001462 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001463 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1464 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1465 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001466
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001467 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1468 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001469
1470
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001471bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1472bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1473bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1474bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1475bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1476bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1477bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001478bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001479bind /<path> [, ...]
1480bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1481bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1482bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001483 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1485 no | yes | yes | no
1486 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001487 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1488 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1489 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1490 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001491 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001492
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001493 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1494 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001495 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1496 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1497 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001498 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1499 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1500 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1501 the range.
1502
1503 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1504 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1505 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1506 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1507 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1508 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1509 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1510 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1511 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001512
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001513 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1514 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1515 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1516 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1517 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1518 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1519 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1520 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1521
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001522 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1523 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1524 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1525 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1526 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1527 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1528 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1529 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001530 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1531 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001532
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001533 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1534 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1535 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1536 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1537 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1538 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
Willy Tarreau48a7e722010-12-24 15:26:39 +01001539 work on other operating systems. It may also not change the
1540 advertised value but change the effective size of outgoing
1541 segments. The commonly advertised value on Ethernet networks
1542 is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is positive,
1543 it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it
1544 will indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's
1545 advertised MSS for outgoing segments. This parameter is only
1546 compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001547
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001548 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1549 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1550 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1551 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001552
1553 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1554
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001555 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1556 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1557 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1558 simply ignore this.
1559
1560 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1561 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1562 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1563 simply ignore this.
1564
1565 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1566 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1567 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1568 this.
1569
1570 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1571 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1572 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1573 this.
1574
1575 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1576 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1577 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1578 this.
1579
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001580 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1581 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1582 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001583 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001584 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1585 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1586 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1587 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001588 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1589 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001590
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001591 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001592 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1593 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1594 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1595 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1596 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1597 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1598 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1599 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1600 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1601 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1602 with front firewalls which would see an established
1603 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1604
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001605 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1606 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1607 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1608 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1609 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1610 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1611 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1612 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1613 This keyword combined with support from external components
1614 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1615 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1616 not even always usable.
1617
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001618 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1619 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1620 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1621 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1622 in a frontend.
1623
1624 Example :
1625 listen http_proxy
1626 bind :80,:443
1627 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001628 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001629
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001630 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001631 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001632
1633
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001634bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1635 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1637 yes | yes | yes | yes
1638 Arguments :
1639 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1640 may be used to override a default value.
1641
1642 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1643 option may be combined with other numbers.
1644
1645 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1646 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1647 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1648 missing from all processes.
1649
1650 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1651 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1652 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1653 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1654
1655 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1656 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1657 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1658 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1659 and 'even' instances.
1660
1661 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1662 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1663 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1664 32.
1665
1666 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1667 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1668
1669 Example :
1670 listen app_ip1
1671 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001672 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001673
1674 listen app_ip2
1675 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001676 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001677
1678 listen management
1679 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001680 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001681
1682 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1683
1684
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001685block { if | unless } <condition>
1686 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1688 no | yes | yes | yes
1689
1690 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1691 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001692 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001693 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001694 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1695 "block" statements per instance.
1696
1697 Example:
1698 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1699 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1700 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1701 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1702
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001703 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001704
1705
1706capture cookie <name> len <length>
1707 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1709 no | yes | yes | no
1710 Arguments :
1711 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1712 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1713 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1714 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1715 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1716
1717 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1718 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1719 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1720 right if it exceeds <length>.
1721
1722 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1723 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1724 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1725 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1726
1727 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1728 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1729 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1730
1731 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1732 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1733 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1734 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001735 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001736 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1737
1738 Example:
1739 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1740
1741 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001742 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001743
1744
1745capture request header <name> len <length>
1746 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1748 no | yes | yes | no
1749 Arguments :
1750 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001751 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001752 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1753 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1754 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1755
1756 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1757 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1758 it exceeds <length>.
1759
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001760 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001761 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1762 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001763 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1764 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1765 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1766 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001767 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001768 environments to find where the request came from.
1769
1770 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1771 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1772 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1773 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001774
1775 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1776 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1777 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1778 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1779
1780 Example:
1781 capture request header Host len 15
1782 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1783 capture request header Referrer len 15
1784
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001785 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001786 about logging.
1787
1788
1789capture response header <name> len <length>
1790 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1792 no | yes | yes | no
1793 Arguments :
1794 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001795 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001796 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1797 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1798 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1799
1800 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1801 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1802 it exceeds <length>.
1803
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001804 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001805 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1806 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1807 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001808 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1809 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1810 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1811 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001812
1813 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1814 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1815 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1816 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1817
1818 Example:
1819 capture response header Content-length len 9
1820 capture response header Location len 15
1821
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001822 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001823 about logging.
1824
1825
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001826clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001827 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1829 yes | yes | yes | no
1830 Arguments :
1831 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1832 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1833 as explained at the top of this document.
1834
1835 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1836 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1837 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1838 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1839 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1840 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1841 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1842 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001843 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001844 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1845 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1846
1847 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1848 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1849 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1850 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1851 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1852 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1853
1854 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1855 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1856
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001857 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1858 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001859
1860
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001861contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001862 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1864 yes | no | yes | yes
1865 Arguments :
1866 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1867 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1868 as explained at the top of this document.
1869
1870 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001871 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001872 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001873 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1874 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1875 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1876 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1877
1878 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1879 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1880 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1881 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1882 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1883 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1884
1885 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1886 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1887 instead.
1888
1889 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1890 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1891
1892
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001893cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001894 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1895 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001896 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1898 yes | no | yes | yes
1899 Arguments :
1900 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1901 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1902 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1903 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1904 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1905 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1906 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1907 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1908 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1909
1910 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1911 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1912 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1913 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1914 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1915 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1916 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1917 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1918 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1919 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1920 "insert" and "prefix".
1921
1922 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001923 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001924
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001925 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001926 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1927 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1928 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1929 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1930 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1931 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1932 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1933 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1934 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1935 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001936
1937 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1938 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1939 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1940 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1941 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1942 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1943 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1944 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1945 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1946 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001947 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1948 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1949 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001950
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001951 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1952 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1953 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001954 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1955 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1956 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1957 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001958 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1959 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1960 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001961
1962 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1963 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1964 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1965 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1966 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1967 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1968 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1969 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1970 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1971
1972 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1973 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1974 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1975 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1976 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1977 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1978 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1979 persistence cookie in the cache.
1980 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1981
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001982 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1983 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1984 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1985 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1986 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1987 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1988 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1989 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1990 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1991 they logout.
1992
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001993 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
1994 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
1995 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
1996 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
1997
1998 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
1999 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2000 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2001 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2002 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2003 this attribute.
2004
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002005 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002006 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002007 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2008 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2009 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2010 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2011 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2012 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002013
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002014 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2015 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2016 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2017 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2018 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2019 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2020 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2021 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2022 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2023 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2024 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2025 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2026 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2027 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2028 the site.
2029
2030 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2031 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2032 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2033 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2034 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2035 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2036 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2037 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2038 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2039 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2040 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2041 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2042 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2043 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2044 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2045 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2046
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002047 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2048 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2049 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2050 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002051
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002052 Examples :
2053 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2054 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2055 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002056 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002057
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002058 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002059 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002060
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002061
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002062default-server [param*]
2063 Change default options for a server in a backend
2064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2065 yes | no | yes | yes
2066 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002067 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2068 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2069 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2070 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002071
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002072 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002073 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2074
2075 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002076
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002077
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002078default_backend <backend>
2079 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2081 yes | yes | yes | no
2082 Arguments :
2083 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2084
2085 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2086 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2087 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2088 will catch all undetermined requests.
2089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002090 Example :
2091
2092 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2093 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2094 default_backend dynamic
2095
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002096 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2097
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002098
2099disabled
2100 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2102 yes | yes | yes | yes
2103 Arguments : none
2104
2105 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2106 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2107 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2108 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2109 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2110 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2111 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2112
2113 See also : "enabled"
2114
2115
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002116dispatch <address>:<port>
2117 Set a default server address
2118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2119 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002120 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002121
2122 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2123 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2124 during start-up.
2125
2126 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2127 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2128 possible with normal servers.
2129
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002130 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002131 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2132 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2133 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2134 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2135
2136 See also : "server"
2137
2138
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002139enabled
2140 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2142 yes | yes | yes | yes
2143 Arguments : none
2144
2145 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2146 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2147
2148 See also : "disabled"
2149
2150
2151errorfile <code> <file>
2152 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2154 yes | yes | yes | yes
2155 Arguments :
2156 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002157 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002158
2159 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002160 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002161 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002162 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2163 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002164
2165 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2166 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2167 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2168
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002169 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2170
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002171 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2172 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2173 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2174 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2175
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002176 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2177 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2178 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2179 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2180 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2181 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2182
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002183 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2184 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2185 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002186 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002187 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2188
2189 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2190
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002191 Example :
2192 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2193 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2194 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2195
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002196
2197errorloc <code> <url>
2198errorloc302 <code> <url>
2199 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2201 yes | yes | yes | yes
2202 Arguments :
2203 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002204 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002205
2206 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2207 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2208 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2209 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2210 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2211
2212 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2213 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2214 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2215
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002216 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2217
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002218 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2219 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2220 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2221 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2222 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2223 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2224 request.
2225
2226 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2227
2228
2229errorloc303 <code> <url>
2230 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2232 yes | yes | yes | yes
2233 Arguments :
2234 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2235 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2236
2237 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2238 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2239 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2240 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2241 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2242
2243 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2244 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2245 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2246
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002247 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2248
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002249 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2250 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2251 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2252 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002253 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002254
2255 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2256
2257
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002258force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2259 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2260 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2261 no | yes | yes | yes
2262
2263 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2264 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2265 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2266 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2267 marked down for maintenance operations.
2268
2269 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2270 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2271 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2272 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2273 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2274 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2275 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2276 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2277 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2278
2279 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2280 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2281 is used.
2282
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002283 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002284 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002285
2286
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002287fullconn <conns>
2288 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2290 yes | no | yes | yes
2291 Arguments :
2292 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2293 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2294
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002295 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002296 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002297 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002298 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2299 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2300 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2301 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2302 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002303 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002304
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002305 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2306 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2307 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2308
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002309 Example :
2310 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2311 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2312 # connections.
2313 backend dynamic
2314 fullconn 10000
2315 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2316 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2317
2318 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2319
2320
2321grace <time>
2322 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002324 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002325 Arguments :
2326 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2327 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2328 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2329
2330 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2331 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002332 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002333 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2334
2335 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2336 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2337 simplify it.
2338
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002339
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002340hash-type <method>
2341 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2343 yes | no | yes | yes
2344 Arguments :
2345 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2346 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2347 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2348 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2349 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2350 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2351 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2352 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2353 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2354
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002355 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2356 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2357 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2358 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2359 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2360 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2361 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2362 this value.
2363
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002364 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2365 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2366 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2367 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2368 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2369 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2370 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2371 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2372 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2373 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2374 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2375 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2376 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2377
2378 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2379
2380 See also : "balance", "server"
2381
2382
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002383http-check disable-on-404
2384 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002386 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002387 Arguments : none
2388
2389 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2390 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2391 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2392 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2393 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2394 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2395 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2396 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002397 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2398 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2399 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2400
2401 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2402
2403
2404http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2405 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002407 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002408 Arguments :
2409 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2410 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002411 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002412 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2413 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2414 details on the supported keywords.
2415
2416 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2417 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2418 with the usual backslash ('\').
2419
2420 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2421 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2422 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2423 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2424 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2425
2426 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2427 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2428 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2429 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2430 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2431
2432 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2433 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2434 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2435 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2436 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2437 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2438
2439 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2440 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2441 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2442 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2443 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2444 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2445 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2446 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2447 trace).
2448
2449 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2450 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2451 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2452 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2453 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2454 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2455 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2456 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2457
2458 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2459 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2460 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2461 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2462 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2463 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2464 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2465 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2466
2467 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2468 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2469
2470 Examples :
2471 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002472 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002473
2474 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002475 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002476
2477 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002478 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002479
2480 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002481 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002482
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002483 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002484
2485
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002486http-check send-state
2487 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2489 yes | no | yes | yes
2490 Arguments : none
2491
2492 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2493 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2494 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2495 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2496 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2497
2498 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2499 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2500 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2501 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2502 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2503 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2504 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2505 checked in multiple backends.
2506
2507 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2508 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2509
2510 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2511 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2512 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2513 one fails.
2514
2515 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2516 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2517 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2518
2519 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2520 server's queue.
2521
2522 Example of a header received by the application server :
2523 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2524 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2525
2526 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2527
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002528http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002529 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002530 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2531
2532 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2533 no | yes | yes | yes
2534
2535 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2536 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2537 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002538 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2539 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002540 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2541
2542 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2543 instance.
2544
2545 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002546 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2547 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2548 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002549
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002550 http-request allow if nagios
2551 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2552 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2553 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002554
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002555 Example:
2556 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002557
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002558 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002559
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002560 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2561 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002562
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002563http-send-name-header [<header>]
2564 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2565
2566 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2567 yes | no | yes | yes
2568
2569 Arguments :
2570
2571 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2572
2573 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2574 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2575 is added with the header string proved.
2576
2577 See also : "server"
2578
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002579id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002580 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2582 no | yes | yes | yes
2583 Arguments : none
2584
2585 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2586 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2587 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002588
2589
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002590ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2591 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2592 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2593 no | yes | yes | yes
2594
2595 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2596 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2597 and running).
2598
2599 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2600 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2601 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2602 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2603 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2604
2605 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2606 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2607
2608 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2609 "unless" condition is met.
2610
2611 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2612
2613
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002614log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002615log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002616no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002617 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2619 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002620
2621 Prefix :
2622 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2623 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2624 prefix does not allow arguments.
2625
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002626 Arguments :
2627 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2628 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2629 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2630 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2631 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2632 parameter.
2633
2634 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2635 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2636
2637 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2638 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2639 standard syslog port).
2640
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002641 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2642 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2643 standard syslog port).
2644
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002645 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2646 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2647 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2648 appropriately writeable).
2649
2650 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2651
2652 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2653 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2654 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2655
2656 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2657 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2658 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002659 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2660 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2661 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2662 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2663 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002664
2665 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2666
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002667 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2668 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2669 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002670
2671 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2672 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2673 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2674 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2675
2676 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2677 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002678
2679 Example :
2680 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002681 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2682 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002683
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002684log-format <string>
2685 Allows you to custom a log line.
2686
2687 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2688
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002689
2690maxconn <conns>
2691 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2693 yes | yes | yes | no
2694 Arguments :
2695 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2696 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2697 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2698 closes.
2699
2700 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2701 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2702 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2703 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2704 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2705 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2706 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2707 properly tuned.
2708
2709 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2710 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2711 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2712
2713 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2714
2715
2716mode { tcp|http|health }
2717 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2719 yes | yes | yes | yes
2720 Arguments :
2721 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2722 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2723 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2724 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2725
2726 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2727 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2728 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2729 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2730 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2731
2732 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2733 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2734 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2735 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2736 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2737 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2738
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002739 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2740 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2741 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002742
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002743 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002744 defaults http_instances
2745 mode http
2746
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002747 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002748
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002749
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002750monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002751 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2753 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002754 Arguments :
2755 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2756 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002757 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002758 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2759 backend and its backup.
2760
2761 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2762 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2763 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2764 servers in a list of backends.
2765
2766 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2767 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2768 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2769 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2770 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2771 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2772 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002773 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2774 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002775
2776 Example:
2777 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002778 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002779 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2780 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2781 monitor-uri /site_alive
2782 monitor fail if site_dead
2783
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002784 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002785
2786
2787monitor-net <source>
2788 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2790 yes | yes | yes | no
2791 Arguments :
2792 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2793 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2794 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2795 followed by a mask.
2796
2797 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2798 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002799 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002800 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2801
2802 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2803 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2804 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2805 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2806 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2807
2808 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2809 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2810 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2811 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2812 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2813
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002814 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2815 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002816
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002817 Example :
2818 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2819 frontend www
2820 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2821
2822 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2823
2824
2825monitor-uri <uri>
2826 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2828 yes | yes | yes | no
2829 Arguments :
2830 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2831 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2832
2833 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2834 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2835 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2836 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2837 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2838 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2839 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2840 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2841
2842 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2843 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2844 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2845 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2846 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2847 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2848
2849 Example :
2850 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2851 frontend www
2852 mode http
2853 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2854
2855 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2856
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002857
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002858option abortonclose
2859no option abortonclose
2860 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2862 yes | no | yes | yes
2863 Arguments : none
2864
2865 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2866 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2867 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2868 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002869 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002870 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2871 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2872 encountered while delivering the response.
2873
2874 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2875 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2876 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2877 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2878 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2879 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002880 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002881 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002882 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002883 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2884 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2885 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2886
2887 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2888 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2889 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2890 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2891 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2892 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2893 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2894 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002895 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002896
2897 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2898 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2899
2900 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2901
2902
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002903option accept-invalid-http-request
2904no option accept-invalid-http-request
2905 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2907 yes | yes | yes | no
2908 Arguments : none
2909
2910 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2911 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2912 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2913 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2914 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2915 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2916 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2917 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002918 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2919 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2920 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2921 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2922 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2923 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002924
2925 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2926 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2927 been confirmed.
2928
2929 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2930 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002931 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2932 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002933 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2934
2935 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2936 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2937
2938 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2939 stats socket.
2940
2941
2942option accept-invalid-http-response
2943no option accept-invalid-http-response
2944 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2946 yes | no | yes | yes
2947 Arguments : none
2948
2949 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2950 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2951 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2952 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2953 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2954 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2955 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2956 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2957 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2958
2959 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2960 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2961 been confirmed.
2962
2963 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2964 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2965 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2966 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2967
2968 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2969 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2970
2971 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2972 stats socket.
2973
2974
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002975option allbackups
2976no option allbackups
2977 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2979 yes | no | yes | yes
2980 Arguments : none
2981
2982 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2983 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2984 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2985 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2986 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2987 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2988 order between the backup servers anymore.
2989
2990 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2991 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2992
2993 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2994 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2995
2996
2997option checkcache
2998no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002999 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3001 yes | no | yes | yes
3002 Arguments : none
3003
3004 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3005 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003006 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003007 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3008 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003009 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003010
3011 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003012 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003013 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003014 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3015 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003016 to the client are :
3017 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003018 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003019 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003020 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3021 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3022 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3023 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3024 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3025 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3026 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3027 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3028 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3029 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3030 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3031
3032 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003033 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003034 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003035 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003036 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3037
3038 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3039 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003040 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003041 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3042
3043 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3044 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3045
3046
3047option clitcpka
3048no option clitcpka
3049 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3051 yes | yes | yes | no
3052 Arguments : none
3053
3054 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3055 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3056 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3057 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3058
3059 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3060 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3061 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3062 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3063
3064 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3065 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3066 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3067 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3068 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3069
3070 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3071
3072 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3073 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3074 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3075
3076 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3077 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3078
3079 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3080
3081
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003082option contstats
3083 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3085 yes | yes | yes | no
3086 Arguments : none
3087
3088 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3089 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3090 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3091 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3092 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3093 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3094 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3095
3096
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003097option dontlog-normal
3098no option dontlog-normal
3099 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3101 yes | yes | yes | no
3102 Arguments : none
3103
3104 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3105 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3106 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3107 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3108 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3109 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3110 logged.
3111
3112 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3113 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3114 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3115
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003116 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003117 logging.
3118
3119
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003120option dontlognull
3121no option dontlognull
3122 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3124 yes | yes | yes | no
3125 Arguments : none
3126
3127 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3128 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3129 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3130 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3131 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3132 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3133 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3134
3135 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3136 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3137 would not be logged.
3138
3139 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3140 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003142 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003143
3144
3145option forceclose
3146no option forceclose
3147 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003149 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003150 Arguments : none
3151
3152 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3153 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3154 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3155 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3156 global session times in the logs.
3157
3158 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003159 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003160 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3161 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3162 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3163 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003164
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003165 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3166 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3167 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3168
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003169 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3170 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3171
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003172 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003173
3174
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003175option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003176 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3178 yes | yes | yes | yes
3179 Arguments :
3180 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3181 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003182 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003183 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003184
3185 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3186 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3187 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3188 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3189 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3190 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3191 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003192 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3193 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3194 possible that the client has already brought one.
3195
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003196 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003197 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003198 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3199 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003200 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3201 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003202
3203 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3204 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3205 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3206 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3207 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3208 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3209 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3210
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003211 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3212 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3213 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3214 are under the control of the end-user.
3215
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003216 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003217 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3218 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003219 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3220 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3221 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003222
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003223 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3224 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3225 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3226 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3227 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003228
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003229 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003230 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3231 frontend www
3232 mode http
3233 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3234
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003235 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3236 backend www
3237 mode http
3238 option forwardfor header X-Client
3239
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003240 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3241 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003242
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003243
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003244option http-no-delay
3245no option http-no-delay
3246 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3248 yes | yes | yes | yes
3249 Arguments : none
3250
3251 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3252 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3253 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3254 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3255 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3256 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3257 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3258 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3259 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3260 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3261 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3262 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3263 affected.
3264
3265 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3266 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3267 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3268 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3269 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3270 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3271 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3272 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3273 latency environments.
3274
3275
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003276option http-pretend-keepalive
3277no option http-pretend-keepalive
3278 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3280 yes | yes | yes | yes
3281 Arguments : none
3282
3283 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3284 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3285 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3286 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3287 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3288 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3289 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3290 consider the response complete.
3291
3292 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3293 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3294 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3295 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3296 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3297 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3298
3299 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3300 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3301 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3302 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3303 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3304 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3305 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3306
3307 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3308 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003309 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
3310 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3311 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003312
3313 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3314 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3315
3316 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3317
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003318
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003319option http-server-close
3320no option http-server-close
3321 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3323 yes | yes | yes | yes
3324 Arguments : none
3325
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003326 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3327 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3328 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3329 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3330 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3331 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3332 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3333 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3334 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3335 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3336 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3337 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003338
3339 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3340 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3341 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3342 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003343 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3344 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003345
3346 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3347 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003348 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3349 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3350 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003351
3352 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3353 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3354
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003355 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3356 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003357
3358
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003359option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003360no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003361 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3363 yes | yes | yes | no
3364 Arguments : none
3365
3366 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3367 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3368 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3369 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3370 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3371 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3372 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3373
3374 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3375 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3376 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3377 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3378 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3379 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3380 request along its whole life.
3381
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003382 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3383 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3384 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3385 front of an existing proxy.
3386
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003387 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3388
3389 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3390 http-server-close".
3391
3392
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003393option httpchk
3394option httpchk <uri>
3395option httpchk <method> <uri>
3396option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3397 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3399 yes | no | yes | yes
3400 Arguments :
3401 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3402 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3403 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3404 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3405 ones.
3406
3407 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3408 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3409 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3410
3411 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3412 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3413 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3414 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3415 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3416
3417 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3418 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3419 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3420 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3421 the lack of any response.
3422
3423 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3424
3425 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3426 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3427 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3428
3429 Examples :
3430 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3431 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3432 backend https_relay
3433 mode tcp
3434 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3435 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3436
3437 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003438 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3439 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003440
3441
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003442option httpclose
3443no option httpclose
3444 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3446 yes | yes | yes | yes
3447 Arguments : none
3448
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003449 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3450 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3451 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3452 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3453 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3454 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3455 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003456
3457 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003458 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3459 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3460 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3461 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3462 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3463 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003464
3465 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3466 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3467 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003468 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3469 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003470
3471 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3472 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3473
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003474 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3475 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003476
3477
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003478option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003479 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3481 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003482 Arguments :
3483 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3484 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3485 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3486 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3487 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003488
3489 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3490 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3491 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3492 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3493 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3494 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3495 ports.
3496
3497 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3498
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003499 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3500 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3501 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3502 by default.
3503
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003504 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003505
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003506
3507option http_proxy
3508no option http_proxy
3509 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3511 yes | yes | yes | yes
3512 Arguments : none
3513
3514 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3515 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3516 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3517 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3518 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3519
3520 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3521 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3522 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3523 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003524 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003525 be analyzed.
3526
3527 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3528 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3529
3530 Example :
3531 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3532 backend direct_forward
3533 option httpclose
3534 option http_proxy
3535
3536 See also : "option httpclose"
3537
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003538
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003539option independant-streams
3540no option independant-streams
3541 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3543 yes | yes | yes | yes
3544 Arguments : none
3545
3546 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3547 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3548 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3549 receive data or not.
3550
3551 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3552 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3553 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3554 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3555 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3556 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3557 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3558 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3559 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3560 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3561 socket buffers.
3562
3563 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3564 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3565 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3566 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3567 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3568
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003569 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003570
3571
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003572option ldap-check
3573 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3575 yes | no | yes | yes
3576 Arguments : none
3577
3578 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3579 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3580 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3581 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3582
3583 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3584 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3585
3586 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3587 configure it.
3588
3589 Example :
3590 option ldap-check
3591
3592 See also : "option httpchk"
3593
3594
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003595option log-health-checks
3596no option log-health-checks
3597 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3599 yes | no | yes | yes
3600 Arguments : none
3601
3602 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3603 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3604 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3605 of additional information is limited.
3606
3607 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3608 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3609
3610 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3611
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003612
3613option log-separate-errors
3614no option log-separate-errors
3615 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3617 yes | yes | yes | no
3618 Arguments : none
3619
3620 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3621 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3622 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3623 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3624 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3625 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3626 provides very important information.
3627
3628 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3629 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3630 error logs.
3631
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003632 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003633 logging.
3634
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003635
3636option logasap
3637no option logasap
3638 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3640 yes | yes | yes | no
3641 Arguments : none
3642
3643 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3644 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3645 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3646 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3647 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3648 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3649 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003650 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003651 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3652 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3653
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003654 Examples :
3655 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3656 mode http
3657 option httplog
3658 option logasap
3659 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3660
3661 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3662 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3663 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3664 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3665
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003666 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003667 logging.
3668
3669
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003670option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3671 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3673 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003674 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003675 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3676 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003677
3678 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3679 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3680 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3681 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3682 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3683 in the MySQL table, like this :
3684
3685 USE mysql;
3686 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3687 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3688
3689 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3690 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3691 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3692 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3693 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3694 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3695 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3696 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3697 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3698
3699 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3700 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003701
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003702 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003703
3704 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3705 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3706 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3707 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3708 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3709 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3710
3711 See also: "option httpchk"
3712
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003713option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3714 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3716 yes | no | yes | yes
3717 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003718 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3719 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003720
3721 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3722 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3723 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3724 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3725
3726 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003727
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003728option nolinger
3729no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003730 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003731 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3732 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003733 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003734
3735 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3736 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3737 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3738 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3739 connections.
3740
3741 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3742 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3743 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3744 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3745 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3746 this too.
3747
3748 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3749 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3750 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3751
3752 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3753 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3754 for servers.
3755
3756 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3757 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3758
3759
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003760option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3761 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3763 yes | yes | yes | yes
3764 Arguments :
3765 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3766 matching <network>
3767 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3768 header name.
3769
3770 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3771 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3772 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3773 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3774 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3775 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3776 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3777 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3778 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3779 possible that the client has already brought one.
3780
3781 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3782 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3783 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3784 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3785 header and requires different one.
3786
3787 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3788 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3789 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3790 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3791 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3792 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3793 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3794
3795 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3796 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3797 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3798 both are defined.
3799
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003800 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3801 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3802 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3803 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3804 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003805
3806 Examples :
3807 # Original Destination address
3808 frontend www
3809 mode http
3810 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3811
3812 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3813 backend www
3814 mode http
3815 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3816
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003817 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3818 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003819
3820
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003821option persist
3822no option persist
3823 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3824 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3825 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003826 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003827
3828 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3829 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3830 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3831 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3832 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3833 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3834 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3835 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3836 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3837 redirected to another valid server.
3838
3839 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3840 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3841
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003842 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003843
3844
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003845option redispatch
3846no option redispatch
3847 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3848 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3849 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003850 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003851
3852 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3853 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3854 be able to access the service anymore.
3855
3856 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3857 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3858
3859 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3860 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3861 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003862
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003863 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3864 "redisp" keywords.
3865
3866 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3867 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3868
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003869 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003870
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003871
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003872option redis-check
3873 Use redis health checks for server testing
3874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3875 yes | no | yes | yes
3876 Arguments : none
3877
3878 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3879 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3880 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3881 find the "+PONG" response message.
3882
3883 Example :
3884 option redis-check
3885
3886 See also : "option httpchk"
3887
3888
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003889option smtpchk
3890option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3891 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3893 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003894 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003895 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3896 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3897 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3898
3899 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3900 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3901 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3902
3903 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3904 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3905 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3906 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3907 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3908 dead server.
3909
3910 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3911 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3912 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3913 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3914
3915 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3916 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3917 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3918 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3919 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3920
3921 Example :
3922 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3923
3924 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3925
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003926
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003927option socket-stats
3928no option socket-stats
3929
3930 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3932 yes | yes | yes | no
3933
3934 Arguments : none
3935
3936
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003937option splice-auto
3938no option splice-auto
3939 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3941 yes | yes | yes | yes
3942 Arguments : none
3943
3944 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3945 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3946 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3947 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003948 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003949 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3950 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3951 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3952 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3953
3954 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3955 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3956 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3957 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3958 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3959 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3960 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3961 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3962 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3963 keyword.
3964
3965 Example :
3966 option splice-auto
3967
3968 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3969 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3970
3971 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3972 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3973
3974
3975option splice-request
3976no option splice-request
3977 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3979 yes | yes | yes | yes
3980 Arguments : none
3981
3982 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3983 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3984 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3985 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3986 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3987 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3988
3989 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3990
3991 Example :
3992 option splice-request
3993
3994 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3995 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3996
3997 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3998 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3999
4000
4001option splice-response
4002no option splice-response
4003 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4005 yes | yes | yes | yes
4006 Arguments : none
4007
4008 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4009 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
4010 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4011 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4012 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4013 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4014
4015 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4016
4017 Example :
4018 option splice-response
4019
4020 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4021 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4022
4023 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4024 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4025
4026
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004027option srvtcpka
4028no option srvtcpka
4029 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4031 yes | no | yes | yes
4032 Arguments : none
4033
4034 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4035 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4036 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4037 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4038
4039 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4040 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4041 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4042 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4043
4044 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4045 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4046 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4047 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4048 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4049
4050 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4051
4052 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4053 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4054 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4055
4056 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4057 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4058
4059 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4060
4061
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004062option ssl-hello-chk
4063 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4065 yes | no | yes | yes
4066 Arguments : none
4067
4068 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4069 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4070 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4071 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4072 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4073 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4074 hello message.
4075
4076 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4077 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4078 messages, which is appreciable.
4079
4080 See also: "option httpchk"
4081
4082
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004083option tcp-smart-accept
4084no option tcp-smart-accept
4085 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4087 yes | yes | yes | no
4088 Arguments : none
4089
4090 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4091 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4092 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4093 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4094 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4095 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4096
4097 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4098 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4099 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4100 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4101
4102 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4103 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4104 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4105 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4106
4107 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4108 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4109 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4110
4111 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4112 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4113 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4114
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004115 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4116
4117
4118option tcp-smart-connect
4119no option tcp-smart-connect
4120 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4122 yes | no | yes | yes
4123 Arguments : none
4124
4125 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4126 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4127 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4128 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4129 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4130
4131 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4132 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4133 complex.
4134
4135 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4136 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4137 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4138
4139 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4140 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4141
4142 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4143
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004144
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004145option tcpka
4146 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4148 yes | yes | yes | yes
4149 Arguments : none
4150
4151 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4152 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4153 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4154 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4155
4156 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4157 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4158 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4159 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4160
4161 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4162 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4163 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4164 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4165 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4166
4167 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4168
4169 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4170 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4171 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4172 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4173 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4174 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4175 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4176 backends.
4177
4178 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4179
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004180
4181option tcplog
4182 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4184 yes | yes | yes | yes
4185 Arguments : none
4186
4187 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4188 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4189 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4190 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4191 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4192 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4193 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4194 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4195
4196 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004198 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004199
4200
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004201option transparent
4202no option transparent
4203 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004205 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004206 Arguments : none
4207
4208 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4209 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4210 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4211 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4212 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4213 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4214 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4215 appropriate server.
4216
4217 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4218 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4219
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004220 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004221 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004222
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004223
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004224persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004225persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004226 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4228 yes | no | yes | yes
4229 Arguments :
4230 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004231 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4232 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004233
4234 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4235 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4236 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4237 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4238 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4239 forwarded to this server.
4240
4241 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4242 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4243 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004244 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004245 a single "listen" section.
4246
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004247 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4248 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4249 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4250
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004251 Example :
4252 listen tse-farm
4253 bind :3389
4254 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4255 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4256 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4257 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4258 persist rdp-cookie
4259 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004260 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004261 balance rdp-cookie
4262 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4263 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4264
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004265 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4266 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004267
4268
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004269rate-limit sessions <rate>
4270 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4272 yes | yes | yes | no
4273 Arguments :
4274 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4275 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4276
4277 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4278 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4279 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4280 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4281 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4282 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4283
4284 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4285 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4286 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4287 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4288
4289 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4290 listen smtp
4291 mode tcp
4292 bind :25
4293 rate-limit sessions 10
4294 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4295
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004296 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4297 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4298 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004299
4300 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4301
4302
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004303redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4304redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004305 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4307 no | yes | yes | yes
4308
4309 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004310 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004311
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004312 Arguments :
4313 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4314 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4315 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4316 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004317 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4318 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4319 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4320 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004321
4322 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4323 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4324 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4325 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4326 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4327 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4328 location with a GET method.
4329
4330 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4331 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4332
4333 - "drop-query"
4334 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4335 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4336 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4337 with a location-type redirect.
4338
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004339 - "append-slash"
4340 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4341 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4342 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4343 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4344
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004345 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4346 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4347 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4348 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4349 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4350 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4351 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4352
4353 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4354 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4355 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4356 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4357 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4358 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4359 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004360
4361 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4362 acl clear dst_port 80
4363 acl secure dst_port 8080
4364 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004365 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004366 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004367 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4368
4369 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004370 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4371 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4372 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004373 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004374
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004375 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4376 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4377 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004379 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004380
4381
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004382redisp (deprecated)
4383redispatch (deprecated)
4384 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4385 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4386 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004387 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004388
4389 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4390 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4391 be able to access the service anymore.
4392
4393 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4394 redistribute them to a working server.
4395
4396 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4397 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4398 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004399
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004400 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4401 "option redispatch" instead.
4402
4403 See also : "option redispatch"
4404
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004405
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004406reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004407 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4409 no | yes | yes | yes
4410 Arguments :
4411 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4412 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004413 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004414
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004415 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4416 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4417
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004418 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4419 the last header of an HTTP request.
4420
4421 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4422 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4423 responses.
4424
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004425 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4426 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4427 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4428
4429 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4430 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004431
4432
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004433reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4434reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004435 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4437 no | yes | yes | yes
4438 Arguments :
4439 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4440 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4441 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4442 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4443 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4444 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4445 ignores case.
4446
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004447 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4448 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4449
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004450 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4451 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4452 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4453 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004454 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004455
4456 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4457 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4458
4459 Example :
4460 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4461 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4462 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4463
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004464 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4465 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004466
4467
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004468reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4469reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004470 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4472 no | yes | yes | yes
4473 Arguments :
4474 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4475 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4476 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4477 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4478 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4479 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4480
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004481 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4482 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4483
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004484 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4485 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4486 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4487 next servers.
4488
4489 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4490 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4491 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4492
4493 Example :
4494 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4495 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4496 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4497
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004498 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4499 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004500
4501
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004502reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4503reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004504 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4506 no | yes | yes | yes
4507 Arguments :
4508 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4509 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4510 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4511 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4512 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4513 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4514 case.
4515
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004516 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4517 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4518
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004519 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4520 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4521 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4522 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004523 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004524
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004525 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004526 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004527 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004528
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004529 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4530 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4531
4532 Example :
4533 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4534 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4535 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4536
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004537 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4538 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004539
4540
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004541reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4542reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004543 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4545 no | yes | yes | yes
4546 Arguments :
4547 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4548 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4549 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4550 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4551 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4552 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4553 case.
4554
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004555 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4556 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4557
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004558 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4559 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4560 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4561 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4562
4563 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4564 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4565
4566 Example :
4567 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4568 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4569 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4570 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4571
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004572 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4573 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004574
4575
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004576reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4577reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004578 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4580 no | yes | yes | yes
4581 Arguments :
4582 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4583 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4584 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4585 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4586 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4587 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4588
4589 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4590 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4591 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4592 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004593 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004594
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004595 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4596 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4597
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004598 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4599 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4600 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4601
4602 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4603 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4604 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4605 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4606 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4607
4608 Example :
4609 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004610 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004611 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4612 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4613
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004614 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4615 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004616
4617
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004618reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4619reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004620 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4622 no | yes | yes | yes
4623 Arguments :
4624 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4625 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4626 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4627 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4628 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4629 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4630 ignores case.
4631
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004632 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4633 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4634
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004635 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4636 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004637 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4638 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4639 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004640 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4641 not set.
4642
4643 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4644 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4645 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4646 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4647 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4648
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004649 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004650 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4651 # block all others.
4652 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4653 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4654
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004655 # block bad guys
4656 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4657 reqitarpit . if badguys
4658
4659 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4660 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004661
4662
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004663retries <value>
4664 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4665 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4666 yes | no | yes | yes
4667 Arguments :
4668 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4669 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4670 default value is 3.
4671
4672 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4673 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4674 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4675
4676 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4677 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4678
4679 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4680 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4681
4682 See also : "option redispatch"
4683
4684
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004685rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004686 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4688 no | yes | yes | yes
4689 Arguments :
4690 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4691 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004692 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004693
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004694 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4695 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4696
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004697 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4698 the last header of an HTTP response.
4699
4700 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4701 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4702 responses.
4703
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004704 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4705 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004706
4707
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004708rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4709rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004710 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4712 no | yes | yes | yes
4713 Arguments :
4714 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4715 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4716 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4717 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4718 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4719 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4720 ignores case.
4721
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004722 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4723 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4724
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004725 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4726 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004727 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004728 client.
4729
4730 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4731 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4732 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4733
4734 Example :
4735 # remove the Server header from responses
4736 reqidel ^Server:.*
4737
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004738 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4739 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004740
4741
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004742rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4743rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004744 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4746 no | yes | yes | yes
4747 Arguments :
4748 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4749 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4750 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4751 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4752 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4753 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4754 ignores case.
4755
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004756 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4757 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4758
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004759 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4760 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4761 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4762 case-sensitive.
4763
4764 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004765 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4766 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4767 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004768
4769 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4770 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4771
4772 Example :
4773 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4774 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4775
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004776 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4777 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004778
4779
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004780rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4781rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004782 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4784 no | yes | yes | yes
4785 Arguments :
4786 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4787 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4788 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4789 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4790 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4791 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4792 ignores case.
4793
4794 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4795 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4796 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4797 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004798 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004799
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004800 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4801 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4802
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004803 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4804 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4805 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4806
4807 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4808 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4809 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4810 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4811 are not case-sensitive.
4812
4813 Example :
4814 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4815 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4816
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004817 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4818 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004819
4820
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004821server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004822 Declare a server in a backend
4823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4824 no | no | yes | yes
4825 Arguments :
4826 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004827 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-server-name" is
4828 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004829
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004830 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4831 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4832 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4833 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004834 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4835 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4836 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4837 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4838 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4839 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004840
4841 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4842 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4843 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4844 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4845 adding this value to the client's port.
4846
4847 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4848 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004849 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004850
4851 Examples :
4852 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4853 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4854
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004855 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4856 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004857
4858
4859source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004860source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004861source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004862 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4864 yes | no | yes | yes
4865 Arguments :
4866 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4867 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4868 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4869 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4870
4871 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4872 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004873 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4874 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4875 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004876
4877 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4878 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4879 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4880 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4881 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4882 <addr>.
4883
4884 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4885 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4886 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4887 port.
4888
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004889 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4890 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4891 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4892 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4893 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4894 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4895 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4896 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4897 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4898 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4899 HTTP header.
4900
4901 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4902 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4903 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4904 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4905 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4906 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4907 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4908 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4909 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4910 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4911
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004912 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4913 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4914 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4915 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4916 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4917 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4918
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004919 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4920 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4921 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4922 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4923
4924 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4925 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4926 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4927 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4928 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4929 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4930
4931 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4932 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4933 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4934 there are two methods :
4935
4936 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4937 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4938 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4939 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4940 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4941 of the client ranges may be used.
4942
4943 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4944 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4945 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4946 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4947 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4948 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4949 same session.
4950
4951 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4952 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4953 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4954 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4955 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4956 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4957
4958 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4959 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4960 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004961 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004962
4963 Examples :
4964 backend private
4965 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4966 source 192.168.1.200
4967
4968 backend transparent_ssl1
4969 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4970 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4971
4972 backend transparent_ssl2
4973 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4974 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4975 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4976
4977 backend transparent_ssl3
4978 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4979 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4980 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4981
4982 backend transparent_smtp
4983 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4984 # with Tproxy version 4.
4985 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4986
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004987 backend transparent_http
4988 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4989 # proxy.
4990 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004992 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004993 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4994
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004995
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004996srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4997 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4999 yes | no | yes | yes
5000 Arguments :
5001 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5002 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5003 as explained at the top of this document.
5004
5005 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5006 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5007 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5008 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5009 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5010 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5011 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5012
5013 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5014 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5015 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5016 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5017 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005018 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005019 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005020 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005021
5022 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5023 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5024 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5025 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5026 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5027 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5028
5029 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5030 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5031
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005032 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5033 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005034
5035
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005036stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5037 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5039 no | no | yes | yes
5040
5041 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5042 matched.
5043
5044 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5045 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5046
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005047 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5048 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5049 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5050
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005051 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5052 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5053 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5054 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005055
5056 Example :
5057 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5058 backend stats_localhost
5059 stats enable
5060 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5061
5062 Example :
5063 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5064 backend stats_auth
5065 stats enable
5066 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5067 stats admin if TRUE
5068
5069 Example :
5070 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5071 userlist stats-auth
5072 group admin users admin
5073 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5074 group readonly users haproxy
5075 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5076
5077 backend stats_auth
5078 stats enable
5079 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5080 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5081 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5082 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5083
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005084 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5085 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5086 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005087
5088
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005089stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5090 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5092 yes | no | yes | yes
5093 Arguments :
5094 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5095
5096 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5097
5098 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5099 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5100 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5101 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5102 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5103 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5104
5105 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5106 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5107 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005108 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005109
5110 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5111 report using "stats scope".
5112
5113 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5114 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5115 unobvious parameters.
5116
5117 Example :
5118 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5119 backend public_www
5120 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5121 stats enable
5122 stats hide-version
5123 stats scope .
5124 stats uri /admin?stats
5125 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5126 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5127 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5128
5129 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5130 backend private_monitoring
5131 stats enable
5132 stats uri /admin?stats
5133 stats refresh 5s
5134
5135 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5136
5137
5138stats enable
5139 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5141 yes | no | yes | yes
5142 Arguments : none
5143
5144 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5145 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5146 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5147 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5148 - stats auth : no authentication
5149 - stats scope : no restriction
5150
5151 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5152 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5153 unobvious parameters.
5154
5155 Example :
5156 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5157 backend public_www
5158 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5159 stats enable
5160 stats hide-version
5161 stats scope .
5162 stats uri /admin?stats
5163 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5164 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5165 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5166
5167 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5168 backend private_monitoring
5169 stats enable
5170 stats uri /admin?stats
5171 stats refresh 5s
5172
5173 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5174
5175
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005176stats hide-version
5177 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5179 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005180 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005181
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005182 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5183 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5184 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5185 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5186 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5187 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005188
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005189 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5190 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5191 unobvious parameters.
5192
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005193 Example :
5194 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5195 backend public_www
5196 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005197 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005198 stats hide-version
5199 stats scope .
5200 stats uri /admin?stats
5201 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5202 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5203 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005204
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005205 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5206 backend private_monitoring
5207 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005208 stats uri /admin?stats
5209 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005210
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005211 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005212
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005213
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005214stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5215 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5216 Access control for statistics
5217
5218 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5219 no | no | yes | yes
5220
5221 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5222 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5223 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5224 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5225 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5226 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5227
5228 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5229 instance.
5230
5231 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5232 about ACL usage.
5233
5234
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005235stats realm <realm>
5236 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5238 yes | no | yes | yes
5239 Arguments :
5240 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5241 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5242 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5243
5244 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5245 using a backslash ('\').
5246
5247 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5248 only related to authentication.
5249
5250 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5251 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5252 unobvious parameters.
5253
5254 Example :
5255 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5256 backend public_www
5257 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5258 stats enable
5259 stats hide-version
5260 stats scope .
5261 stats uri /admin?stats
5262 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5263 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5264 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5265
5266 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5267 backend private_monitoring
5268 stats enable
5269 stats uri /admin?stats
5270 stats refresh 5s
5271
5272 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5273
5274
5275stats refresh <delay>
5276 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5278 yes | no | yes | yes
5279 Arguments :
5280 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5281 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5282 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5283 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5284 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5285 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5286
5287 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5288 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5289 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5290 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5291
5292 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5293 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5294 unobvious parameters.
5295
5296 Example :
5297 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5298 backend public_www
5299 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5300 stats enable
5301 stats hide-version
5302 stats scope .
5303 stats uri /admin?stats
5304 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5305 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5306 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5307
5308 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5309 backend private_monitoring
5310 stats enable
5311 stats uri /admin?stats
5312 stats refresh 5s
5313
5314 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5315
5316
5317stats scope { <name> | "." }
5318 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5320 yes | no | yes | yes
5321 Arguments :
5322 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5323 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5324 section in which the statement appears.
5325
5326 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5327 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5328 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5329 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5330 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5331 exists.
5332
5333 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5334 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5335 unobvious parameters.
5336
5337 Example :
5338 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5339 backend public_www
5340 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5341 stats enable
5342 stats hide-version
5343 stats scope .
5344 stats uri /admin?stats
5345 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5346 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5347 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5348
5349 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5350 backend private_monitoring
5351 stats enable
5352 stats uri /admin?stats
5353 stats refresh 5s
5354
5355 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5356
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005357
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005358stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005359 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5361 yes | no | yes | yes
5362
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005363 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005364 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5365
5366 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5367 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5368
5369 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5370 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005371 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005372
5373 Example :
5374 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5375 backend private_monitoring
5376 stats enable
5377 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5378 stats uri /admin?stats
5379 stats refresh 5s
5380
5381 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5382 global section.
5383
5384
5385stats show-legends
5386 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5387 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5388 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5389 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5390 - IP (socket, server)
5391 - cookie (backend, server)
5392
5393 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5394 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005395 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005396
5397 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5398
5399
5400stats show-node [ <name> ]
5401 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5403 yes | no | yes | yes
5404 Arguments:
5405 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5406 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5407
5408 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5409 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005410 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005411
5412 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5413 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5414 unobvious parameters.
5415
5416 Example:
5417 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5418 backend private_monitoring
5419 stats enable
5420 stats show-node Europe-1
5421 stats uri /admin?stats
5422 stats refresh 5s
5423
5424 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5425 section.
5426
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005427
5428stats uri <prefix>
5429 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5431 yes | no | yes | yes
5432 Arguments :
5433 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5434 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5435 query string.
5436
5437 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5438 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5439 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5440 possible to reach it in the application.
5441
5442 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005443 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005444 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5445 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5446 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5447 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5448
5449 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5450 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5451 an address or a port to statistics only.
5452
5453 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5454 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5455 unobvious parameters.
5456
5457 Example :
5458 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5459 backend public_www
5460 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5461 stats enable
5462 stats hide-version
5463 stats scope .
5464 stats uri /admin?stats
5465 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5466 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5467 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5468
5469 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5470 backend private_monitoring
5471 stats enable
5472 stats uri /admin?stats
5473 stats refresh 5s
5474
5475 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5476
5477
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005478stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5479 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005481 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005482
5483 Arguments :
5484 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5485 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5486 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5487 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5488
5489 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5490 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5491 the "stick-table" statement.
5492
5493 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5494 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5495 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5496 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5497 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5498
5499 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5500 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5501 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5502 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5503 transformation rules.
5504
5505 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5506 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5507 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5508 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5509 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5510 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5511 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5512
5513 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5514 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5515 ACL based conditions.
5516
5517 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5518 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5519 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5520 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5521
5522 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5523 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5524 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5525 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5526
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005527 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5528 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5529 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5530
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005531 Example :
5532 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5533 # last 30 minutes
5534 backend pop
5535 mode tcp
5536 balance roundrobin
5537 stick store-request src
5538 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5539 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5540 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5541
5542 backend smtp
5543 mode tcp
5544 balance roundrobin
5545 stick match src table pop
5546 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5547 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5548
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005549 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5550 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005551
5552
5553stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5554 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5556 no | no | yes | yes
5557
5558 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5559 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5560 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5561 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5562
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005563 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5564 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5565 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5566
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005567 Examples :
5568 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005569 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005570
5571 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5572 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5573 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5574
5575
5576 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5577 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5578 backend http
5579 mode http
5580 balance roundrobin
5581 stick on src table https
5582 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5583 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5584 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5585
5586 backend https
5587 mode tcp
5588 balance roundrobin
5589 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5590 stick on src
5591 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5592 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5593
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005594 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005595
5596
5597stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5598 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5600 no | no | yes | yes
5601
5602 Arguments :
5603 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5604 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5605 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5606 server is selected.
5607
5608 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5609 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5610 the "stick-table" statement.
5611
5612 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5613 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5614 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5615 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5616 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5617 address.
5618
5619 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5620 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5621 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5622 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5623 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5624 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5625 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5626 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5627 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5628 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5629
5630 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5631 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5632 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5633 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5634 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5635 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5636 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5637
5638 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5639 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5640 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5641 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5642
5643 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5644 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5645 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5646 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5647 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5648 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5649 another protocol or access method.
5650
5651 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5652 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5653 the request.
5654
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005655 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5656 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5657 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5658
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005659 Example :
5660 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5661 # last 30 minutes
5662 backend pop
5663 mode tcp
5664 balance roundrobin
5665 stick store-request src
5666 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5667 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5668 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5669
5670 backend smtp
5671 mode tcp
5672 balance roundrobin
5673 stick match src table pop
5674 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5675 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5676
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005677 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5678 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005679
5680
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005681stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005682 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5683 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005684 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005686 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005687
5688 Arguments :
5689 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5690 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5691 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5692 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5693
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005694 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5695 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5696 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5697 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5698
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005699 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5700 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5701 instance.
5702
5703 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5704 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5705 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5706 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5707 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5708 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005709 to 32 characters.
5710
5711 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5712 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5713 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5714 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5715 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5716 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005717
5718 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005719 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5720 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005721 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5722 increase.
5723
5724 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005725 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5726 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5727 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005728
5729 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5730 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5731 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5732 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5733 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5734 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5735 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5736 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5737 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5738 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5739 parameter (see below).
5740
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005741 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5742 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5743 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5744 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5745 soft restart.
5746
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005747 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5748
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005749 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5750 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5751 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5752 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5753 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005754 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005755 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5756 if not expiration delay is specified.
5757
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005758 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5759 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5760 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5761 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005762 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5763 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5764 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5765 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5766 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5767 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5768 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5769 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5770 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5771 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5772 types and their arguments.
5773
5774 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5775 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5776 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5777 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5778
5779 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5780 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5781 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5782 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5783
5784 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5785 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5786 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5787 they were received.
5788
5789 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5790 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5791 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5792 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5793 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5794
5795 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5796 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5797 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5798 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5799 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5800
5801 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5802 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5803 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5804
5805 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5806 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5807 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5808 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5809 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5810
5811 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5812 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5813 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5814 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5815 the client side.
5816
5817 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5818 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5819 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5820 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5821 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5822 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5823 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5824
5825 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5826 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5827 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5828 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5829 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5830 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5831 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5832
5833 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5834 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5835 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5836 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5837 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5838 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5839
5840 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5841 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5842 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5843 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5844
5845 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5846 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5847 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5848 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5849 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5850 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5851 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5852 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5853 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5854 recommended for better fairness.
5855
5856 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5857 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5858 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5859 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5860
5861 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5862 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5863 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5864 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5865 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5866 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5867 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5868 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5869 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5870 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005871
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005872 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5873 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005874 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5875 reference it.
5876
5877 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5878 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5879 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5880 as an exclusive stickiness.
5881
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005882 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5883 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5884 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5885 something that can be ignored.
5886
5887 Example:
5888 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5889 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5890 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5891 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5892
5893 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005894 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005895
5896
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005897stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5898 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5900 no | no | yes | yes
5901
5902 Arguments :
5903 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5904 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5905 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5906 server is selected.
5907
5908 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5909 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5910 the "stick-table" statement.
5911
5912 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5913 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5914 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5915 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5916
5917 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5918 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5919 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5920 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5921 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5922 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005923 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005924 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5925 rules.
5926
5927 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5928 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5929 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5930 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5931 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5932 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5933 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5934
5935 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5936 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5937 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5938 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5939
5940 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5941 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5942 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5943 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5944 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5945 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5946 another protocol or access method.
5947
5948 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5949
5950 Example :
5951 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5952 backend https
5953 mode tcp
5954 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005955 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005956 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005957
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005958 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5959 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5960
5961 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5962 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5963 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5964
5965 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5966 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005967
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005968 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5969 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5970 # at offset 44.
5971
5972 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5973 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5974
5975 # Learn on response if server hello.
5976 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005977
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005978 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5979 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5980
5981 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5982 extraction.
5983
5984
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005985tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5986 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5988 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005989 Arguments :
5990 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5991 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5992 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005993
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005994 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005995
5996 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5997 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005998 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5999 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6000 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6001 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6002 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6003 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006004
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006005 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6006 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6007 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6008 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006009
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006010 Three types of actions are supported :
6011 - accept :
6012 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6013 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6014 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006015
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006016 - reject :
6017 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6018 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6019 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6020 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6021 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6022 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6023 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6024 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6025 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6026 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6027 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6028 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006029
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006030 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6031 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6032 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6033 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6034 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6035 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6036 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6037 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6038 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006039
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006040 These actions take one or two arguments :
6041 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6042 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6043 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006044
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006045 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6046 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6047 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6048 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006049
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006050 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6051 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6052 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6053 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6054 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6055 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6056 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6057 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6058 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6059 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006060
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006061 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6062 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6063 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006064
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006065 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6066 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6067 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006068
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006069 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006070 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006071 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006072
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006073 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6074 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6075 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006076
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006077 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6078 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6079 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006080
6081 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6082
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006083 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006084
6085
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006086tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6087 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006089 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006090 Arguments :
6091 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6092 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6093 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006094
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006095 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006096
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006097 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6098 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6099 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6100 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6101 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006102
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006103 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6104 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6105 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6106 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6107 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6108 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6109 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6110 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6111 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006112
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006113 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6114 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6115 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6116 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006117
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006118 Three types of actions are supported :
6119 - accept :
6120 - reject :
6121 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006122
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006123 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6124 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006125
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006126 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6127 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6128 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6129 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6130 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6131 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006132
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006133 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006134 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6135 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006136
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006137 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006138 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6139 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6140 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6141 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6142 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006143
6144 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006145 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6146 # and reject everything else.
6147 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6148 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006149 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006150 tcp-request content reject
6151
6152 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006153 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6154 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6155 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006156 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006157
6158 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6159 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6160 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006161 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006162 tcp-request content reject
6163
6164 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6165 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6166
6167 frontend http
6168 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6169 # protecting all our sites
6170 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6171 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6172 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6173 ...
6174 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6175
6176 backend http_dynamic
6177 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6178 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6179 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6180 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6181 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6182 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6183 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006184
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006185 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006186
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006187 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006188
6189
6190tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6191 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006193 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006194 Arguments :
6195 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6196 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6197 as explained at the top of this document.
6198
6199 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6200 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6201 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6202 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6203 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6204
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006205 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6206 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6207 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6208 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6209
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006210 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6211 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006212 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006213 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006214 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6215 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6216 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6217 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006218
6219 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6220 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6221 it pass through unaffected.
6222
6223 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6224 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6225 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006226 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006227 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6228 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006229 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6230 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6231 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006232
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006233 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006234 "timeout client".
6235
6236
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006237tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6238 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6240 no | no | yes | yes
6241 Arguments :
6242 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6243 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6244 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6245
6246 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6247
6248 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6249 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6250 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6251 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006252 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006253
6254 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6255
6256 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6257 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6258 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6259 inserted.
6260
6261 Two types of actions are supported :
6262 - accept :
6263 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6264 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6265 the rules evaluation.
6266
6267 - reject :
6268 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6269 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6270 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediatly closed.
6271
6272 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6273 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6274 for changing the default action to a reject.
6275
6276 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-reponse content"
6277 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has been
6278 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6279 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6280 period.
6281
6282 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6283
6284 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6285
6286
6287tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6288 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6290 no | no | yes | yes
6291 Arguments :
6292 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6293 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6294 as explained at the top of this document.
6295
6296 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6297
6298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006299timeout check <timeout>
6300 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6301 established.
6302
6303 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6304 yes | no | yes | yes
6305 Arguments:
6306 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6307 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6308 as explained at the top of this document.
6309
6310 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6311 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6312 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6313 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006314 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6315 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6316 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006317
6318 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6319 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6320
6321 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6322 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006323 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006324
6325 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6326 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6327 forget about it.
6328
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006329 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6330 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006331
6332
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006333timeout client <timeout>
6334timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6335 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6337 yes | yes | yes | no
6338 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006339 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006340 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6341 as explained at the top of this document.
6342
6343 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6344 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6345 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6346 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6347 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6348 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6349 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6350 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006351 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006352 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006353 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6354 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6355 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006356
6357 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6358 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6359 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6360 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6361 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6362 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6363
6364 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6365 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6366 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6367
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006368 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006369
6370
6371timeout connect <timeout>
6372timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6373 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6375 yes | no | yes | yes
6376 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006377 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006378 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6379 as explained at the top of this document.
6380
6381 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006382 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006383 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006384 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006385 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6386 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006387
6388 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6389 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6390 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6391 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6392 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6393 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6394
6395 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6396 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6397 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6398
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006399 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6400 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006401
6402
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006403timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6404 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6406 yes | yes | yes | yes
6407 Arguments :
6408 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6409 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6410 as explained at the top of this document.
6411
6412 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6413 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6414 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6415 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6416 once the request has started to present itself.
6417
6418 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6419 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6420 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6421 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6422 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6423
6424 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6425 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6426 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6427 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6428
6429 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6430 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6431 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6432 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6433 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006434 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006435
6436 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6437 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6438 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6439 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6440
6441 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6442
6443
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006444timeout http-request <timeout>
6445 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006447 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006448 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006449 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006450 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6451 as explained at the top of this document.
6452
6453 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6454 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6455 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6456 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6457 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6458 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6459 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6460 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6461
6462 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6463 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006464 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6465 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006466
6467 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6468 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6469 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6470 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6471 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6472
6473 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006474 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6475 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6476 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006477
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006478 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006479
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006480
6481timeout queue <timeout>
6482 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6484 yes | no | yes | yes
6485 Arguments :
6486 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6487 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6488 as explained at the top of this document.
6489
6490 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6491 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6492 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6493 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6494 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6495
6496 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6497 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6498 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6499 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6500
6501 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6502
6503
6504timeout server <timeout>
6505timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6506 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6508 yes | no | yes | yes
6509 Arguments :
6510 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6511 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6512 as explained at the top of this document.
6513
6514 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6515 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6516 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6517 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6518 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6519 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6520 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6521
6522 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6523 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6524 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6525 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6526 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006527 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006528 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006529 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6530 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6531 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6532 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006533
6534 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6535 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6536 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6537 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6538 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6539 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6540
6541 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6542 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6543 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6544
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006545 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006546
6547
6548timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006549 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6551 yes | yes | yes | yes
6552 Arguments :
6553 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6554 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6555 as explained at the top of this document.
6556
6557 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6558 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6559 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6560
6561 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6562 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6563 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6564 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006565 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006566
6567 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6568
6569
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006570timeout tunnel <timeout>
6571 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6573 yes | no | yes | yes
6574 Arguments :
6575 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6576 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6577 as explained at the top of this document.
6578
6579 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectionnal connection is established
6580 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6581 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6582 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6583 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6584 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6585 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6586 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6587 specified.
6588
6589 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6590 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6591 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6592 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6593 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6594
6595 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6596 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6597 forget about it.
6598
6599 Example :
6600 defaults http
6601 option http-server-close
6602 timeout connect 5s
6603 timeout client 30s
6604 timeout client 30s
6605 timeout server 30s
6606 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6607
6608 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6609
6610
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006611transparent (deprecated)
6612 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006614 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006615 Arguments : none
6616
6617 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6618 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6619 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6620 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6621 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6622 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6623 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6624 appropriate server.
6625
6626 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6627
6628 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6629 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6630
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006631 See also: "option transparent"
6632
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006633unique-id-format <string>
6634 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6636 yes | yes | yes | no
6637 Arguments :
6638 <string> is a log-format string.
6639
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006640 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6641 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6642 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6643 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006644
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006645 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6646 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6647 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6648 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6649 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6650 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6651 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6652 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006653
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006654 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6655 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006656
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006657 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006658
6659 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6660
6661 will generate:
6662
6663 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6664
6665 See also: "unique-id-header"
6666
6667unique-id-header <name>
6668 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6670 yes | yes | yes | no
6671 Arguments :
6672 <name> is the name of the header.
6673
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006674 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6675 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006676
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006677 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006678
6679 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6680 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6681
6682 will generate:
6683
6684 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6685
6686 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006687
6688use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6689use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006690 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6692 no | yes | yes | no
6693 Arguments :
6694 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006696 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006697
6698 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6699 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6700 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006701 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6702 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6703 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6704 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006705
6706 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6707 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6708 assign the backend.
6709
6710 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6711 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6712 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6713 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6714 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6715 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6716
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006717 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006718 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006719 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6720 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6721 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6722
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006723 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006724
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006725
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006726use-server <server> if <condition>
6727use-server <server> unless <condition>
6728 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6730 no | no | yes | yes
6731 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006732 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006733
6734 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6735
6736 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6737 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6738 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6739
6740 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6741 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6742 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6743 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6744 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6745 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6746 matches will assign the server.
6747
6748 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6749 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6750 with the next rules until one matches.
6751
6752 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6753 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6754 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6755 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6756
6757 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6758 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6759 stripped.
6760
6761 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6762 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6763 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6764 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6765
6766 Example :
6767 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6768 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6769 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6770 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6771 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6772 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6773 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6774 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6775 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6776
6777 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6778
6779
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010067805. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006781------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006782
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006783The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6784which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6785arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6786settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6787after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6788Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6789address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006791 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006792 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006794The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006795
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02006796addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006797 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6798 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6799 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6800 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6801 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006802
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006803 Supported in default-server: No
6804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006805backup
6806 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6807 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6808 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6809 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6810 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6811 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006812
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006813 Supported in default-server: No
6814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006815check
6816 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01006817 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
6818 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
6819 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
6820 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
6821 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
6822 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
6823 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
6824 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
6825 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
6826 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006827
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006828 Supported in default-server: No
6829
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006830cookie <value>
6831 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6832 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6833 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6834 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6835 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6836 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6837 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6838
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006839 Supported in default-server: No
6840
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006841disabled
6842 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6843 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6844 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6845 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6846 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6847
6848 Supported in default-server: No
6849
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006850error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006851 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6852 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6853 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006854
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006855 Supported in default-server: Yes
6856
6857 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006858
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006859fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006860 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6861 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6862 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6863
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006864 Supported in default-server: Yes
6865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006866id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006867 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6868 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6869 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006870
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006871 Supported in default-server: No
6872
6873inter <delay>
6874fastinter <delay>
6875downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006876 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6877 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6878 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6879 between checks depending on the server state :
6880
6881 Server state | Interval used
6882 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6883 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6884 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6885 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6886 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6887 or yet unchecked. |
6888 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6889 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6890 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006891
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006892 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6893 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6894 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6895 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6896 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6897 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6898 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6899 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6900 servers.
6901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006902 Supported in default-server: Yes
6903
6904maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006905 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6906 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6907 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6908 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6909 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6910 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6911 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6912 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6913
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006914 Supported in default-server: Yes
6915
6916maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006917 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6918 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6919 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6920 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6921 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6922 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6923 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6924
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006925 Supported in default-server: Yes
6926
6927minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006928 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6929 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6930 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6931 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6932 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6933 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006934 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006935 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006936
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006937 Supported in default-server: Yes
6938
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09006939non-stick
6940 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
6941 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
6942 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
6943
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006944observe <mode>
6945 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6946 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6947 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6948 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6949 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6950 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01006951 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006952
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006953 Supported in default-server: No
6954
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006955 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006957on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006958 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6959 Currently, four modes are available:
6960 - fastinter: force fastinter
6961 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6962 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6963 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6964 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6965
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006966 Supported in default-server: Yes
6967
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006968 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6969
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09006970on-marked-down <action>
6971 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
6972 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07006973 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
6974 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
6975 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
6976 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
6977 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
6978 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
6979 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
6980 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09006981
6982 Actions are disabled by default
6983
6984 Supported in default-server: Yes
6985
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07006986on-marked-up <action>
6987 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
6988 Currently one action is available:
6989 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
6990 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
6991 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
6992 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
6993 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
6994 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
6995 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
6996 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
6997
6998 Actions are disabled by default
6999
7000 Supported in default-server: Yes
7001
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007002port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007003 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7004 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7005 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7006 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7007 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7008 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7009
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007010 Supported in default-server: Yes
7011
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007012redir <prefix>
7013 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7014 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7015 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7016 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7017 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7018 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7019 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7020 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007021 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007022 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7023 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7024 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7025 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7026 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7027
7028 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007030 Supported in default-server: No
7031
7032rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007033 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7034 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7035 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7036
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007037 Supported in default-server: Yes
7038
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007039send-proxy
7040 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7041 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7042 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7043 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7044 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7045 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7046 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7047 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7048 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
7049 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
7050 option of the "bind" keyword.
7051
7052 Supported in default-server: No
7053
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007054slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007055 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7056 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7057 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7058 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7059 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7060 parameters :
7061
7062 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7063 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7064
7065 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7066 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7067 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7068 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7069
7070 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7071 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7072 seen as failed.
7073
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007074 Supported in default-server: Yes
7075
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007076source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007077source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007078source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007079 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7080 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7081 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7082 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7083
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007084 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7085 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7086 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7087 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7088 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7089 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7090 server.
7091
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007092 Supported in default-server: No
7093
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007094track [<proxy>/]<server>
7095 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7096 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7097 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7098 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7099 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7100
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007101 Supported in default-server: No
7102
7103weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007104 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7105 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7106 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007107 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7108 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7109 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7110 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7111 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7112 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007113
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007114 Supported in default-server: Yes
7115
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007116
71176. HTTP header manipulation
7118---------------------------
7119
7120In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7121response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7122request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7123which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7124against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7125to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7126passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7127headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7128never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7129
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007130There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7131(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7132rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7133messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7134in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007135happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007136add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7137normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7138
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007139This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7140in section 4.2 :
7141
7142 - reqadd <string>
7143 - reqallow <search>
7144 - reqiallow <search>
7145 - reqdel <search>
7146 - reqidel <search>
7147 - reqdeny <search>
7148 - reqideny <search>
7149 - reqpass <search>
7150 - reqipass <search>
7151 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7152 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7153 - reqtarpit <search>
7154 - reqitarpit <search>
7155 - rspadd <string>
7156 - rspdel <search>
7157 - rspidel <search>
7158 - rspdeny <search>
7159 - rspideny <search>
7160 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7161 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7162
7163With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7164is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7165parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7166prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7167Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7168
7169 \t for a tab
7170 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7171 \n for a new line (LF)
7172 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7173 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7174 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7175 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7176 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7177
7178The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7179portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7180above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7181regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
71829 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7183is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7184
7185The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7186after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7187
7188Notes related to these keywords :
7189---------------------------------
7190 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7191 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7192 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7193
7194 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7195 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7196 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7197
7198 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7199 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7200 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7201 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7202 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7203
7204 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7205 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7206 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7207 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7208 useless headers before adding new ones.
7209
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007210 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007211 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7212
7213 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7214 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7215 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7216
7217 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7218 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007219 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007220
7221
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010072227. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7223------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007224
7225The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7226content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7227from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7228simple :
7229
7230 - define test criteria with sets of values
7231 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7232
7233The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7234
7235In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7236
7237 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7238
7239This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7240Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7241and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7242an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7243of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7244
7245ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7246'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7247which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7248
7249There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7250performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7251
7252The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7253
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007254 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7255 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007256 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7257
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007258The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7259specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7260possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007261multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7262be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7263needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7264space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7265match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7266lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7267duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
7268to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
7269instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007270
7271 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7272
7273In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7274the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7275case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7276too.
7277
7278Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7279a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7280ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7281
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007282Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007283
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007284 - integers or integer ranges
7285 - strings
7286 - regular expressions
7287 - IP addresses and networks
7288
7289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072907.1. Matching integers
7291----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007292
7293Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7294that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7295expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7296may be omitted.
7297
7298For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7299unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7300representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7301
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007302As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7303two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7304instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7305ranges and operators.
7306
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007307For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007308operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7309Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7310of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007311
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007312Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007313
7314 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7315 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7316 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7317 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7318 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7319
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007320For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007321
7322 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7323
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007324This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7325
7326 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7327
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007328
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073297.2. Matching strings
7330---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007331
7332String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7333exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7334characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7335string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7336to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007337before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007338
7339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073407.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7341-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007342
7343Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7344they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7345possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7346passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7347the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007348the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7349match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007350
7351
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020073527.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007353----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007354
7355IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7356netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7357within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007358host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007359difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7360at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7361does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7362parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007363
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007364IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7365Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7366trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7367IPv6 patterns.
7368
7369HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7370following situations :
7371 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7372 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7373 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7374 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7375 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7376 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7377 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7378 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7379 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7380 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7381
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073837.5. Available matching criteria
7384--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007385
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073867.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7387------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007388
7389A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7390analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
7391addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
7392
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007393always_false
7394 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7395 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7396
7397always_true
7398 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7399 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7400
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007401avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007402avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007403 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7404 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7405 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7406 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7407 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7408 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7409 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7410 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7411 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7412 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7413 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007414
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007415be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007416be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007417 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7418 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7419 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7420 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7421 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007422
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007423be_id <integer>
7424 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7425 backend it was called.
7426
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007427be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007428be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007429 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7430 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7431 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7432 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7433 sucking of an online dictionary).
7434
7435 Example :
7436 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7437 backend dynamic
7438 mode http
7439 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7440 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007441
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007442connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007443connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007444 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007445 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007446 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7447
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007448 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7449 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007450
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007451 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007452 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7453 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7454 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7455 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7456 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007457 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007458
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007459 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7460 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7461 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7462 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007463
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007464dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007465 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
7466 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007467
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007468dst_conn <integer>
7469 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7470 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7471 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7472 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7473 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7474 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7475
7476dst_port <integer>
7477 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7478 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7479
7480fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007481fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007482 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7483 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7484 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7485 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7486 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7487 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7488 criteria.
7489
7490fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007491 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007492 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007493
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007494fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007495fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007496 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7497 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7498 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7499 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7500 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7501 the rate to go down below the limit.
7502
7503 Example :
7504 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7505 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7506 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7507 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7508 frontend mail
7509 bind :25
7510 mode tcp
7511 maxconn 100
7512 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7513 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7514 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7515 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007516
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007517nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007518nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007519 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7520 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7521 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7522 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7523 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007524
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007525queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007526queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007527 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7528 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7529 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7530 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7531 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7532 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7533 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7534
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007535sc1_bytes_in_rate
7536sc2_bytes_in_rate
7537 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7538 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7539 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7540
7541sc1_bytes_out_rate
7542sc2_bytes_out_rate
7543 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7544 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7545 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7546
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007547sc1_clr_gpc0
7548sc2_clr_gpc0
7549 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7550 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7551 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7552 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7553 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
7554 was verified :
7555
7556 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7557 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7558 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7559 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7560 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
7561 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7562 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7563
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007564sc1_conn_cnt
7565sc2_conn_cnt
7566 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7567 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7568
7569sc1_conn_cur
7570sc2_conn_cur
7571 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7572 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7573 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7574
7575sc1_conn_rate
7576sc2_conn_rate
7577 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7578 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7579 See also src_conn_rate.
7580
7581sc1_get_gpc0
7582sc2_get_gpc0
7583 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7584 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7585
7586sc1_http_err_cnt
7587sc2_http_err_cnt
7588 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7589 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7590 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7591
7592sc1_http_err_rate
7593sc2_http_err_rate
7594 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7595 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7596 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7597 src_http_err_rate.
7598
7599sc1_http_req_cnt
7600sc2_http_req_cnt
7601 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7602 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7603 src_http_req_cnt.
7604
7605sc1_http_req_rate
7606sc2_http_req_rate
7607 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7608 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7609 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7610 src_http_req_rate.
7611
7612sc1_inc_gpc0
7613sc2_inc_gpc0
7614 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7615 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7616 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7617 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7618 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7619 when a first ACL was verified :
7620
7621 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7622 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7623 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7624
7625sc1_kbytes_in
7626sc2_kbytes_in
7627 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7628 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7629 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7630 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7631
7632sc1_kbytes_out
7633sc2_kbytes_out
7634 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7635 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7636 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7637 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7638
7639sc1_sess_cnt
7640sc2_sess_cnt
7641 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7642 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7643 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7644 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
7645 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
7646 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7647
7648sc1_sess_rate
7649sc2_sess_rate
7650 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7651 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7652 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7653 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7654 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
7655 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
7656
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007657so_id <integer>
7658 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7659
7660src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007661 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
7662 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
7663 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007664
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007665src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007666src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007667 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7668 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7669 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007670 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007671
7672src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007673src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007674 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7675 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7676 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007677 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007678
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007679src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
7680src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
7681 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7682 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7683 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
7684 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
7685 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
7686 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7687
7688 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7689 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7690 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7691 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7692 acl save src_clr_gpc0
7693 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7694 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7695
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007696src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007697src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007698 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7699 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7700 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007701 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007702
7703src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007704src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007705 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7706 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7707 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007708 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007709
7710src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007711src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007712 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7713 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7714 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007715 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007716
7717src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007718src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007719 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7720 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7721 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007722 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007723
7724src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007725src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007726 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7727 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7728 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007729 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007730
7731src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007732src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007733 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7734 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7735 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7736 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007737 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007738
7739src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007740src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007741 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7742 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7743 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007744 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007745
7746src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007747src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007748 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7749 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7750 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7751 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007752 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007753
7754src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007755src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007756 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7757 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7758 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7759 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7760 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7761 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7762
7763 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7764 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007765 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007766
7767src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007768src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007769 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7770 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7771 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7772 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007773 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007774
7775src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007776src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007777 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7778 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7779 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7780 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007781 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007782
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007783src_port <integer>
7784 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007785
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007786src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007787src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007788 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7789 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7790 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7791 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007792 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007793
7794src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007795src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007796 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7797 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7798 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7799 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007800 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007801
7802src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007803src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007804 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007805 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7806 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007807 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7808 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7809 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007810 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007811
7812 Example :
7813 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7814 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7815 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7816 listen ssh
7817 bind :22
7818 mode tcp
7819 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007820 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007821 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7822 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7823
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007824srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02007825 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
7826 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
7827 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
7828 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
7829
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007830srv_id <integer>
7831 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7832
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007833srv_is_up(<server>)
7834srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7835 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7836 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7837 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7838 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7839 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7840 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7841 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7842 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7843
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007844table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007845table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007846 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
7847 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
7848
7849table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007850table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007851 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
7852 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
7853 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
7854
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007855
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020078567.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7857---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007858
7859A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7860during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007861through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7862keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007863
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007864rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7865 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7866 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7867 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
7868 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7869
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007870req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007871 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007872 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7873 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7874 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7875 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7876 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7877 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7878
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007879req_proto_http
7880 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7881 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007882 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007883 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7884 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7885
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007886req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007887req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007888 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7889 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7890 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7891 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7892 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7893 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7894 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7895 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7896
7897req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007898req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007899 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7900 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7901 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7902 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7903 cookies.
7904
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007905req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7906 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7907 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7908 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
7909 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7910
7911req_ssl_sni <string>
7912 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7913 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
7914 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
7915 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
7916 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
7917 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
7918 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
7919 hello (type 1), like in the example below.
7920
7921 Examples :
7922 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
7923 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7924 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
7925 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
7926 default_backend bk_sorry_page
7927
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007928req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7929 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7930 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7931 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7932 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7933 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7934 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7935 with TCP request content inspection.
7936
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007937wait_end
7938 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7939 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7940 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7941 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7942 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7943 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7944 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7945 inspection.
7946
7947 Examples :
7948 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7949 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7950 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7951
7952 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7953 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7954 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7955 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7956 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7957 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7958 tcp-request content reject
7959
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007960
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079617.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7962--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007963
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007964A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007965application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7966read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7967than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7968
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02007969cook(<name>) <string>
7970 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
7971 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
7972 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
7973 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
7974 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
7975 sent by the server.
7976
7977 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
7978 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
7979 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
7980
7981 cook(profile) silver gold
7982
7983cook_beg(<name>) <string>
7984 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
7985 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
7986 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7987
7988cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
7989 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
7990 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
7991 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
7992 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
7993 server.
7994
7995cook_dir(<name>) <string>
7996 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
7997 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7998 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
7999 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8000 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8001
8002cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8003 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8004 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8005 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8006 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8007
8008cook_end(<name>) <string>
8009 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8010 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8011 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8012
8013cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8014 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8015 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8016 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8017 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8018 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8019
8020cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8021 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8022 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8023 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8024 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8025 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8026
8027cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8028 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8029 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8030 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8031
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008032cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8033 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8034 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8035 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8036 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8037 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8038
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008039hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008040hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008041 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8042 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8043 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8044 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008045 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8046 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8047 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8048 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8049 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008050
8051 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008052 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008053 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8054
8055 hdr(Connection) -i close
8056
8057hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008058hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008059 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8060 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8061 response headers sent by the server.
8062
8063hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008064hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008065 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8066 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8067 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8068 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8069 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8070 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8071 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8072
8073hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008074hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008075 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8076 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8077 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8078 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8079 headers sent by the server.
8080
8081hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008082hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008083 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8084 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8085 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8086 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8087 server.
8088
8089hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008090hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008091 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8092 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8093 response headers sent by the server.
8094
8095hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008096hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8097 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8098 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8099 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008100 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8101
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008102hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008103hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008104 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8105 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8106 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8107 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8108
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008109hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008110hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008111 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008112 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8113 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8114 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8115 response headers sent by the server.
8116
8117hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008118hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008119 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8120 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8121 response headers sent by the server.
8122
8123hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008124hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008125 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8126 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8127 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8128 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8129
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008130http_auth(<userlist>)
8131http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008132 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8133 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8134 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8135 of specified groups.
8136
8137 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8138
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008139http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008140 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8141 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8142 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8143 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8144
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008145method <string>
8146 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8147 already check for most common methods.
8148
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008149path <string>
8150 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8151 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8152 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8153
8154path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008155 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8156 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008157
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008158path_dir <string>
8159 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8160 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8161 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8162 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8163
8164path_dom <string>
8165 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8166 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8167 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8168
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008169path_end <string>
8170 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8171 control file name extension.
8172
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008173path_len <integer>
8174 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8175 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8176
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008177path_reg <regex>
8178 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8179 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8180 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8181
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008182path_sub <string>
8183 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8184 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8185 "path_dir".
8186
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02008187payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
8188 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
8189 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
8190 strings.
8191
8192payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
8193 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
8194 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
8195 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
8196 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
8197 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
8198
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008199req_ver <string>
8200 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8201 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8202
8203status <integer>
8204 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8205 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8206 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8207
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008208url <string>
8209 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
8210 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
8211
8212url_beg <string>
8213 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
8214 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
8215
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008216url_dir <string>
8217 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8218 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8219 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8220 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8221
8222url_dom <string>
8223 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8224 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8225 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8226
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008227url_end <string>
8228 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
8229 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008230
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008231url_ip <address>
8232 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
8233 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
8234 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008235
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008236url_len <integer>
8237 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
8238 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8239
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008240url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008241 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
8242 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008243 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008244 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008245
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008246url_reg <regex>
8247 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8248 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8249 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008250
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008251url_sub <string>
8252 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8253 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008254
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008255urlp(<name>) <string>
8256 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
8257 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
8258
8259 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
8260 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
8261
8262urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
8263 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
8264 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
8265 protocol scheme.
8266
8267urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
8268 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
8269 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
8270 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
8271 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
8272
8273urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
8274 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8275 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
8276 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
8277 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
8278
8279urlp_end(<name>) <string>
8280 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
8281
8282urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008283 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8284 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008285
8286urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
8287 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
8288 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8289
8290urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
8291 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
8292 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8293 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
8294 "urlp_" criteria.
8295
8296urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
8297 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
8298 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
8299 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
8300
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083027.6. Pre-defined ACLs
8303---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008305Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
8306every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008307order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008308
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008309ACL name Equivalent to Usage
8310---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008311FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008312HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008313HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
8314HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008315HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
8316HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
8317HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
8318HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
8319LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008320METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
8321METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
8322METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
8323METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
8324METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
8325METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008326RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008327REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008328TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008329WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
8330---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008331
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008332
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083337.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
8334----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008335
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008336Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8337combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008338
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008339 - AND (implicit)
8340 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8341 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008342
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008343A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008345 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008346
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008347Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8348indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008349
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008350For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8351"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8352requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8353is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008355 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8356 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8357 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8358 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008359
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008360To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8361and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008363 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8364 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8365 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8366 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008367
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008368 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8369 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8370 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8371 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008372
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008373It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8374expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8375be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
8376the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
8377
8378 The following rule :
8379
8380 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8381 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8382
8383 Can also be written that way :
8384
8385 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8386
8387It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8388to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8389simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8390sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8391good use is the following :
8392
8393 With named ACLs :
8394
8395 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8396 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8397 monitor fail if site_dead
8398
8399 With anonymous ACLs :
8400
8401 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8402
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008403See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008404
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01008405
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010084067.8. Pattern extraction
8407-----------------------
8408
8409The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
8410response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
8411for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
8412
8413All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
8414"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
8415begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
8416arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
8417much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
8418equivalent used in ACLs.
8419
8420The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
8421
8422 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008423 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8424 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8425 according to RFC 4291.
8426
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008427 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
8428 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8429 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008430 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8431 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8432 according to RFC 4291.
8433
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008434 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
8435 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
8436 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
8437 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
8438 type integer and only works with such tables.
8439
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008440 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
8441 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
8442 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
8443 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
8444 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
8445 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
8446 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01008447 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02008448
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008449 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008450 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
8451 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
8452 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
8453 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008454
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008455 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008456 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
8457 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
8458 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
8459 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
8460 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
8461 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
8462 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
8463 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008464
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008465 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
8466 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
8467 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
8468 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
8469
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008470 url_param(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008471 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
8472 the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value
8473 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url
8474 (e.g. http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
8475 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008476
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008477 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008478 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
8479 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
8480 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
8481 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008482
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008483 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
8484 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
8485 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
8486 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
8487 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
8488 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
8489 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008490
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008491 Example :
8492 listen tse-farm
8493 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
8494 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8495 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8496 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8497 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8498 persist rdp-cookie
8499 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
8500 # This is only useful makes sense if
8501 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
8502 stick-table type string size 204800
8503 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
8504 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8505 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008506
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008507 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
8508 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008509
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008510 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008511 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008512 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
8513 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
8514 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
8515 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
8516 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
8517 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008518
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008519 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008520
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008521 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008522 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
8523 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
8524 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
8525
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008526 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8527 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
8528 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
8529 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
8530 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008531
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008532 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008533
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008534
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008535The currently available list of transformations include :
8536
8537 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
8538 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8539 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8540
8541 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
8542 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8543 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8544
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008545 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01008546 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
8547 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8548 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8549 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8550
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008551
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085528. Logging
8553----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008554
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008555One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
8556provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
8557very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
8558provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
8559state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008560to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008561headers.
8562
8563In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
8564about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
8565send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
8566
8567 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
8568 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
8569 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
8570 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
8571 at the termination.
8572
8573The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
8574allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
8575as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
8576while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
8577real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
8578delay.
8579
8580
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085818.1. Log levels
8582---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008583
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008584TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008585source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008586HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
8587in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
8588track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
8589syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
8590about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008591
8592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085938.2. Log formats
8594----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008595
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008596HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008597and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
8598slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
8599options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008600
8601 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
8602 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
8603 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
8604 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
8605 extents.
8606
8607 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
8608 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
8609 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
8610 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
8611 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
8612
8613 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
8614 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
8615 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
8616 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
8617 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
8618
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008619 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
8620 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
8621 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
8622 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
8623
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008624 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
8625
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008626Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
8627specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
8628field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
8629servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
8630always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
8631identifier.
8632
8633Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
8634 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
8635 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
8636 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
8637 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
8638
8639
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086408.2.1. Default log format
8641-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008642
8643This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
8644as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
8645format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
8646
8647 Example :
8648 listen www
8649 mode http
8650 log global
8651 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8652
8653 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
8654 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
8655 (www/HTTP)
8656
8657 Field Format Extract from the example above
8658 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
8659 2 'Connect from' Connect from
8660 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
8661 4 'to' to
8662 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
8663 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
8664
8665Detailed fields description :
8666 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
8667 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
8668 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
8669 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
8670 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8671 and processed the connection.
8672 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
8673
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008674In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
8675"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
8676connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
8677
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008678It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
8679will eventually disappear.
8680
8681
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086828.2.2. TCP log format
8683---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008684
8685The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
8686is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
8687information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
8688counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
8689emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
8690environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
8691the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
8692sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008693specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
8694not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
8695fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
8696marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008697
8698 Example :
8699 frontend fnt
8700 mode tcp
8701 option tcplog
8702 log global
8703 default_backend bck
8704
8705 backend bck
8706 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8707
8708 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
8709 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
8710 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
8711
8712 Field Format Extract from the example above
8713 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
8714 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
8715 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
8716 4 frontend_name fnt
8717 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
8718 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
8719 7 bytes_read* 212
8720 8 termination_state --
8721 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
8722 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8723
8724Detailed fields description :
8725 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008726 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8727 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8728 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8729 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8730 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008731
8732 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008733 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8734 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8735 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008736
8737 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
8738 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
8739 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
8740 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
8741
8742 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8743 and processed the connection.
8744
8745 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8746 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8747 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
8748 applications.
8749
8750 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8751 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8752 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8753 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
8754 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
8755
8756 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8757 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8758 See "Timers" below for more details.
8759
8760 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8761 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8762 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
8763 "Timers" below for more details.
8764
8765 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8766 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8767 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8768 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8769 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8770 details.
8771
8772 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8773 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8774 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8775 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8776 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8777
8778 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8779 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8780 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8781 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8782 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8783 for more details.
8784
8785 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8786 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8787 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8788 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8789 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008790 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008791
8792 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8793 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8794 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8795 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8796 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8797 caused by a denial of service attack.
8798
8799 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8800 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8801 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8802 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8803 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8804 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8805 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8806 denial of service attack.
8807
8808 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8809 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8810 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8811 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8812 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8813 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8814 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8815 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
8816 be processed than on other servers.
8817
8818 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8819 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8820 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8821 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8822 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8823 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8824 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8825 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8826 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8827 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8828 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8829 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8830 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8831
8832 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8833 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8834 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8835 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8836 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8837 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8838 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8839 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8840
8841 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8842 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8843 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8844 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8845 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8846 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8847 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8848 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8849 occurs.
8850
8851
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088528.2.3. HTTP log format
8853----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008854
8855The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
8856is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
8857the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
8858are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
8859emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
8860generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
8861"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
8862which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008863frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
8864is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008865
8866Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
8867slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
8868with a star ('*') after the field name below.
8869
8870 Example :
8871 frontend http-in
8872 mode http
8873 option httplog
8874 log global
8875 default_backend bck
8876
8877 backend static
8878 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8879
8880 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8881 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8882 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008883 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008884
8885 Field Format Extract from the example above
8886 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
8887 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
8888 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
8889 4 frontend_name http-in
8890 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
8891 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
8892 7 status_code 200
8893 8 bytes_read* 2750
8894 9 captured_request_cookie -
8895 10 captured_response_cookie -
8896 11 termination_state ----
8897 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
8898 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8899 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
8900 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
8901 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008902
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008903
8904Detailed fields description :
8905 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008906 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8907 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8908 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8909 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8910 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008911
8912 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008913 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8914 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8915 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008916
8917 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
8918 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
8919 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
8920 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
8921 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
8922
8923 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8924 and processed the connection.
8925
8926 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8927 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8928 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
8929
8930 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8931 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8932 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8933 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
8934 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
8935 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
8936
8937 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
8938 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
8939 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
8940 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
8941 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
8942 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
8943
8944 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8945 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8946 See "Timers" below for more details.
8947
8948 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8949 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8950 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
8951 below for more details.
8952
8953 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
8954 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
8955 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
8956 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
8957 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
8958 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
8959 for more details.
8960
8961 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8962 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8963 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8964 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8965 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8966 details.
8967
8968 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
8969 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
8970 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
8971
8972 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
8973 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
8974 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
8975 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
8976 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
8977 overflowing.
8978
8979 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
8980 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
8981 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
8982 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
8983 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
8984 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
8985 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
8986 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8987
8988 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
8989 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
8990 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
8991 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
8992 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
8993 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
8994 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
8995 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8996
8997 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8998 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8999 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
9000 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
9001 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
9002 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
9003 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
9004
9005 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
9006 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
9007 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
9008 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
9009 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009010 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009011 system.
9012
9013 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9014 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9015 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9016 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9017 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9018 caused by a denial of service attack.
9019
9020 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9021 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9022 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9023 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9024 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9025 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9026 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9027 denial of service attack.
9028
9029 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9030 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9031 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9032 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9033 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9034 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9035 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9036 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
9037 processed than on other servers.
9038
9039 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9040 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9041 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9042 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9043 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9044 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9045 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9046 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9047 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9048 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9049 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9050 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9051 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9052
9053 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9054 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9055 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9056 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9057 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9058 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9059 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9060 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9061
9062 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9063 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9064 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9065 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9066 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9067 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9068 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9069 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9070 occurs.
9071
9072 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
9073 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
9074 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
9075 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
9076 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
9077 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
9078 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
9079 cookies" below for more details.
9080
9081 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
9082 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
9083 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
9084 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
9085 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
9086 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
9087 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
9088 and cookies" below for more details.
9089
9090 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
9091 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
9092 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
9093 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
9094 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
9095 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
9096 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
9097 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
9098
9099
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020091008.2.4. Custom log format
9101------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009102
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009103The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
9104mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009105
9106HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
9107Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
9108separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
9109prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
9110
9111Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
9112variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
9113string formats ("Q").
9114
9115Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
9116HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
9117
9118Flags are :
9119 * Q: quote a string
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009120 * X: hexadecimal represenation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009121
9122 Example:
9123
9124 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
9125 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
9126
9127At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
9128
9129 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009130 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009131
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009132the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009133
9134 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009135 %ms\ %f\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009136 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
9137
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009138and the default TCP format is defined this way :
9139
9140 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
9141 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
9142
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009143Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
9144
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009145 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9146 | H | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
9147 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9148 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
9149 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9150 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009151 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009152 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009153 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +01009154 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009155 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
9156 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
9157 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009158 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009159 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
9160 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
9161 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009162 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
9163 | * | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
9164 | * | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009165 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009166 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
9167 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
9168 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
9169 | | %b | backend_name | string |
9170 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
9171 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
9172 | * | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009173 | * | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009174 | * | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
9175 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
9176 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
9177 | * | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
9178 | * | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
9179 | * | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
9180 | * | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
9181 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009182 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009183 | * | %r | http_request | string |
9184 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
9185 | | %s | server_name | string |
9186 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
9187 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
9188 | * | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009189 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009190 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009191 | * | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009192 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009193
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009194*: mode http only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009195
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091968.3. Advanced logging options
9197-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009198
9199Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
9200just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
9201options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
9202for more information about their usage.
9203
9204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
9206------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009207
9208It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
9209haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
9210commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
9211monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
9212ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
9213
9214 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
9215 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
9216 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
9217 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
9218
9219 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
9220 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
9221 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
9222 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
9223 such as other load-balancers.
9224
9225 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
9226 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
9227 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
9228
9229
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092308.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
9231----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009232
9233The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
9234what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
9235or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
9236"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
9237just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
9238log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
9239after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
9240is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
9241with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
9242with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
9243
9244
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092458.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
9246------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009247
9248Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
9249for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
9250"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
9251retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
9252raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
9253a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
9254file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
9255you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
9256"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
9257
9258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092598.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
9260--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009261
9262Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
9263multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
9264them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
9265"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
9266logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
9267error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
9268and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
9269too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
9270useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
9271alternative.
9272
9273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092748.4. Timing events
9275------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009276
9277Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
9278reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
9279the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
9280frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
9281mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
9282
9283 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
9284 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
9285 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
9286 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
9287 the client closes prematurely or times out.
9288
9289 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
9290 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
9291 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
9292 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
9293 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
9294
9295 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
9296 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
9297 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
9298 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
9299 connection never established.
9300
9301 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
9302 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
9303 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
9304 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
9305 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
9306 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
9307 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
9308 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
9309 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
9310 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
9311 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
9312
9313 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
9314 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
9315 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
9316 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
9317 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
9318
9319 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
9320
9321 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
9322 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
9323 negative.
9324
9325These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
9326protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
9327that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009328due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009329close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
9330session has been aborted on timeout.
9331
9332Most common cases :
9333
9334 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9335 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
9336 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
9337 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
9338 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
9339 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
9340 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
9341 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
9342 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02009343 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
9344 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
9345 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009346
9347 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9348 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
9349 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
9350 of ms on remote networks.
9351
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009352 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
9353 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
9354 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009355
9356 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
9357 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
9358 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
9359 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
9360 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
9361 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
9362 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
9363 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
9364 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
9365 to the server until another one is released.
9366
9367Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
9368
9369 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
9370 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
9371 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
9372
9373 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
9374 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
9375 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
9376
9377 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
9378 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
9379 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
9380 flags.
9381
9382 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
9383 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
9384 Check the session termination flags, then check the
9385 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
9386 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
9387 the client connection was maintained open.
9388
9389 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
9390 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
9391 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
9392 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
9393
9394
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093958.5. Session state at disconnection
9396-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009397
9398TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
9399"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
94002-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
9401each of which has a special meaning :
9402
9403 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
9404 session to terminate :
9405
9406 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
9407
9408 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
9409 server explicitly refused it.
9410
9411 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
9412 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
9413 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
9414 error in server response which might have caused information leak
9415 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
9416 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
9417
9418 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
9419 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
9420 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
9421 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
9422 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
9423
9424 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
9425 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
9426 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
9427 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
9428 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
9429
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +09009430 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
9431 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
9432
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009433 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
9434 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
9435 backup connections when going up.
9436
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +02009437 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
9438
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009439 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
9440 send or receive data.
9441
9442 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
9443 send or receive data.
9444
9445 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
9446 with nothing left in the buffers.
9447
9448 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
9449
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01009450 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009451 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
9452
9453 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
9454 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
9455 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
9456 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
9457 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
9458
9459 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
9460 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
9461
9462 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
9463 server (HTTP only).
9464
9465 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
9466
9467 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
9468 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
9469 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
9470
9471 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
9472 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
9473 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
9474
9475 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
9476
9477 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
9478 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
9479
9480 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
9481 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
9482 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
9483
9484 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
9485 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02009486 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
9487 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009488
9489 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
9490 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
9491 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
9492 another server.
9493
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009494 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009495 server.
9496
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009497 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
9498 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
9499 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
9500 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9501
9502 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
9503 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
9504 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
9505 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9506
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +02009507 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
9508 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
9509 "use-server" rule).
9510
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009511 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9512
9513 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
9514 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
9515
9516 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
9517
9518 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
9519 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
9520 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
9521
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009522 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
9523 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
9524 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
9525 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
9526 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
9527
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009528 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
9529
9530 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
9531 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
9532
9533 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
9534
9535 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9536
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009537The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
9538was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009539helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
9540starvation, attacks, etc...
9541
9542The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
9543alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
9544easier finding and understanding.
9545
9546 Flags Reason
9547
9548 -- Normal termination.
9549
9550 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
9551 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
9552 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
9553 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
9554
9555 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
9556 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
9557 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
9558 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
9559 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
9560 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009561
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009562 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9563 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009564 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009565
9566 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
9567 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
9568 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
9569
9570 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
9571 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
9572 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
9573 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
9574 the server takes too long to respond.
9575
9576 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
9577 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
9578 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
9579 long a time to respond.
9580
9581 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
9582 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
9583 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
9584 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
9585 and the client.
9586
9587 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
9588 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
9589 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
9590 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
9591 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
9592 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
9593
9594 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
9595 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009596 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
9597 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
9598 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
9599 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009600
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009601 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009602 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
9603 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
9604 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
9605 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
9606 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
9607
9608 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
9609 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
9610 503 or 504 here.
9611
9612 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
9613 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
9614 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
9615 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
9616 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
9617
9618 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9619 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009620 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009621 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
9622 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
9623
9624 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
9625 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
9626 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
9627 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
9628 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
9629 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
9630 between haproxy and the server.
9631
9632 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
9633 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
9634 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
9635 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
9636 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
9637 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
9638 solution is to fix the application.
9639
9640 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
9641 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
9642 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
9643 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
9644 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
9645 external attacks.
9646
9647 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
9648 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009649 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009650 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
9651 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
9652
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009653 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
9654 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
9655 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
9656 the client.
9657
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009658 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
9659 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
9660 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
9661 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009662 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
9663 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
9664 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
9665 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
9666 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009667
9668 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
9669 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
9670 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
9671 returned an HTTP 403 error.
9672
9673 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
9674 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
9675 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
9676 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
9677
9678 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
9679 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
9680 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
9681 only be solved by proper system tuning.
9682
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009683The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
9684persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
9685important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
9686re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
9687
9688 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
9689
9690 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9691 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
9692 set on a GET request.
9693
9694 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
9695 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
9696 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
9697 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
9698
9699 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
9700 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
9701 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
9702
9703 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9704 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
9705 already got a cookie.
9706
9707 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9708 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
9709 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
9710 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
9711 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
9712
9713 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9714 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9715 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9716
9717 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
9718 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9719 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9720
9721 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
9722 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
9723
9724 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
9725 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
9726 then advertised in the response.
9727
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009728
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097298.6. Non-printable characters
9730-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009731
9732In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
9733consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
9734converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
9735prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
9736being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
9737escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
9738is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
9739'}' when logging headers.
9740
9741Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
9742issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
9743containing spaces is "User-Agent".
9744
9745Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
9746the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
9747performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
9748
9749
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097508.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
9751---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009752
9753Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
9754achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009755section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009756cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
9757the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
9758the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009759locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009760not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
9761user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
9762a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
9763wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
9764
9765 Examples :
9766 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
9767 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
9768
9769 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
9770 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
9771
9772
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097738.8. Capturing HTTP headers
9774---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009775
9776Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
9777proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
9778the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
9779server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
9780
9781Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
9782response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009783section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009784
9785It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009786time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
9787appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009788are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
9789and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
9790follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
9791request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
9792in the logs.
9793
9794 Example :
9795 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
9796 listen proxy-out
9797 mode http
9798 option httplog
9799 option logasap
9800 log global
9801 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
9802
9803 # log the name of the virtual server
9804 capture request header Host len 20
9805
9806 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
9807 capture request header Content-Length len 10
9808
9809 # log the beginning of the referrer
9810 capture request header Referer len 20
9811
9812 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
9813 capture response header Server len 20
9814
9815 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
9816 capture response header Content-Length len 10
9817
9818 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
9819 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
9820
9821 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
9822 capture response header Via len 20
9823
9824 # log the URL location during a redirection
9825 capture response header Location len 20
9826
9827 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
9828 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
9829 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9830 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
9831 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
9832
9833 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9834 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9835 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9836 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009837 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009838
9839 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9840 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9841 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9842 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
9843 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009844 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009845
9846
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098478.9. Examples of logs
9848---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009849
9850These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
9851them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
9852reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
9853
9854 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
9855 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9856 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9857
9858 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
9859 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
9860
9861 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
9862 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
9863 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9864
9865 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
9866 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
9867
9868 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
9869 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9870 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9871
9872 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009873 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009874 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
9875 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
9876
9877 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
9878 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
9879 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
9880
9881 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
9882 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009883 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009884 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
9885 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
9886 to return the 502 and not the server.
9887
9888 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009889 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009890
9891 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
9892 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
9893 Nothing was sent to any server.
9894
9895 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
9896 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
9897
9898 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
9899 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
9900 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
9901 send a 408 return code to the client.
9902
9903 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
9904 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
9905
9906 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
9907 5 seconds ("c----").
9908
9909 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
9910 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009911 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009912
9913 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009914 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009915 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
9916 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
9917 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
9918 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
9919 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009920
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009921
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020099229. Statistics and monitoring
9923----------------------------
9924
9925It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
9926mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
9927CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
9928Unix socket.
9929
9930
99319.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009932---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009933
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01009934The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
9935page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
9936
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009937 0. pxname: proxy name
9938 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
9939 for server)
9940 2. qcur: current queued requests
9941 3. qmax: max queued requests
9942 4. scur: current sessions
9943 5. smax: max sessions
9944 6. slim: sessions limit
9945 7. stot: total sessions
9946 8. bin: bytes in
9947 9. bout: bytes out
9948 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009949 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009950 12. ereq: request errors
9951 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009952 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009953 15. wretr: retries (warning)
9954 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01009955 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009956 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
9957 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
9958 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
9959 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
9960 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
9961 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
9962 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
9963 25. qlimit: queue limit
9964 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
9965 27. iid: unique proxy id
9966 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
9967 29. throttle: warm up status
9968 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
9969 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009970 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02009971 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
9972 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
9973 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009974 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009975 UNK -> unknown
9976 INI -> initializing
9977 SOCKERR -> socket error
9978 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
9979 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
9980 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
9981 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
9982 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
9983 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
9984 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
9985 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
9986 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
9987 disable-on-404
9988 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
9989 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
9990 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009991 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
9992 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009993 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
9994 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
9995 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
9996 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
9997 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
9998 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009999 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
10000 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
10001 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
10002 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010003 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
10004 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010005
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100079.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010008-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010009
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010010The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010011must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
10012is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
10013a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
10014risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
10015followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
10016given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
10017then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
10018to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010019
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010020It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
10021on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
10022own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010023
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010024clear counters
10025 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
10026 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
10027 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
10028 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
10029 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10030
10031clear counters all
10032 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
10033 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
10034 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
10035
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010036clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
10037 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
10038
10039 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
10040 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
10041 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
10042 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
10043 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
10044 later after the session ends is usual enough.
10045
10046 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
10047
10048 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
10049 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
10050 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
10051 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
10052 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
10053 the ACLs :
10054
10055 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10056 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10057 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10058 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10059 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10060 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10061
10062 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010063 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
10064 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010065
10066 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010067 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010068 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010069 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10070 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10071 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10072 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010073
10074 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10075
10076 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010077 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010078 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10079 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010080 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10081 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10082 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010083
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010084disable frontend <frontend>
10085 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
10086 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
10087 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
10088 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
10089 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
10090 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
10091 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
10092 on the stats page.
10093
10094 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10095 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10096
10097 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10098 level "admin".
10099
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010100disable server <backend>/<server>
10101 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
10102 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
10103 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
10104 during the maintenance.
10105
10106 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
10107 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
10108
10109 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010110 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010111
10112 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10113 level "admin".
10114
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010115enable frontend <frontend>
10116 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
10117 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
10118 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
10119 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
10120 which was disabled.
10121
10122 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10123 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10124
10125 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10126 level "admin".
10127
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010128enable server <backend>/<server>
10129 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
10130 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
10131
10132 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010133 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010134
10135 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10136 level "admin".
10137
10138get weight <backend>/<server>
10139 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
10140 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
10141 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
10142 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
10143 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010144 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010145
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010146help
10147 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
10148 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010149
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010150prompt
10151 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
10152 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
10153 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
10154 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
10155 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
10156 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
10157 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
10158 command.
10159
10160quit
10161 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010162
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020010163set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
10164 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any non-null
10165 positive value is allowed, but setting values larger than the global maxconn
10166 does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections were
10167 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10168 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10169 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
10170 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10171
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020010172set maxconn global <maxconn>
10173 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
10174 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
10175 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10176 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10177 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
10178 setting.
10179
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020010180set rate-limit connections global <value>
10181 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
10182 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
10183 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
10184 is passed in number of connections per second.
10185
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010186set timeout cli <delay>
10187 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
10188 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
10189 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
10190
10191set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
10192 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
10193 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
10194 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
10195 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
10196 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
10197 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
10198 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
10199 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
10200 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
10201 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
10202 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
10203 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
10204 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010205 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010206
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010207show errors [<iid>]
10208 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
10209 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010210 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
10211 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
10212 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010213
10214 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
10215 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
10216 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
10217 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
10218 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
10219 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
10220 are reported too.
10221
10222 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
10223 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
10224 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
10225 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
10226 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
10227 code.
10228
10229 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
10230 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
10231 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
10232 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
10233 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
10234 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
10235 line.
10236
10237 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010238 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10239 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010240 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
10241 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
10242
10243 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
10244 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
10245 00038 Location: blah\r\n
10246 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
10247 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
10248 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
10249 00204+ minal\r\n
10250 00211 \r\n
10251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010252 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010253 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
10254 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
10255 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
10256 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
10257 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
10258 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010259
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010260show info
10261 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
10262
10263show sess
10264 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010265 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
10266 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10267
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010010268show sess <id>
10269 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
10270 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10271 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
10272 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
10273 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
10274 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010275
10276show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
10277 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
10278 possible to dump only selected items :
10279 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
10280 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
10281 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
10282 for example:
10283 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
10284 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
10285 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
10286
10287 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010288 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
10289 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010290 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
10291 Release_date: 2009/09/23
10292 Nbproc: 1
10293 Process_num: 1
10294 (...)
10295
10296 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
10297 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
10298 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
10299 (...)
10300 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
10301
10302 $
10303
10304 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
10305 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
10306 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
10307 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010308 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010309
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010310show table
10311 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
10312 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
10313 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
10314 entries currently in use.
10315
10316 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010317 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010318 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
10319 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010320
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010321show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010322 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
10323 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
10324 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010325 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
10326
10327 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
10328 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
10329 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
10330 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
10331 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
10332
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010333 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10334 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10335 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10336 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10337 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10338 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10339
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010340
10341 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010342 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
10343 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010344
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010345 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010346 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010347 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010348 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10349 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10350 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10351 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010352
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010353 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010354 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010355 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10356 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010357
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010358 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
10359 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010360 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010361 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10362 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010363
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010364 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
10365 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010366 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010367 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10368 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
10369
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010370 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
10371 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
10372 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
10373 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
10374 time goes, the average event rate drops.
10375
10376 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
10377 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
10378 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010379 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
10380 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010381 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
10382 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020010383
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010384shutdown frontend <frontend>
10385 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
10386 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
10387 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
10388 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
10389 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
10390 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
10391 once it is terminated.
10392
10393 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10394 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10395
10396 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10397 level "admin".
10398
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020010399shutdown session <id>
10400 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
10401 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10402 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
10403 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
10404 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
10405 flag in the logs.
10406
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020010407shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
10408 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
10409 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
10410 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
10411 'K' flag in the logs.
10412
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010413/*
10414 * Local variables:
10415 * fill-column: 79
10416 * End:
10417 */